Upload
others
View
4
Download
0
Embed Size (px)
Citation preview
STRING ALGEBRAS IN
REPRESENTATION THEORY
A thesis submitted to the University of Manchester
for the degree of Doctor of Philosophy
in the Faculty of Engineering and Physical Sciences
2016
Rosanna Laking
School of Mathematics
Contents
Abstract 6
Declaration 7
Copyright Statement 8
Acknowledgements 9
I The module category 19
1 The functor category and Ziegler spectrum 20
1.1 The functor category . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
1.1.1 The category of finitely presented functors . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
1.1.2 Extensions of functors along direct limits . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24
1.2 The Ziegler spectrum . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25
1.3 Dimensions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27
1.3.1 Cantor-Bendixson rank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
1.3.2 Krull-Gabriel dimension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
1.3.3 m-dimension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
1.3.4 Fundamental bijections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
1.3.5 Localisation with respect to a hereditary torsion pair . . . . . . 34
1.3.6 Artin algebras and fp idempotent ideals . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
1.4 Representation type . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
1.5 Elementary duality . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41
2
2 String algebras 43
2.1 Definition of a string algebra . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43
2.2 Strings and bands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44
2.2.1 Finite strings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
2.2.2 Bands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
2.2.3 Infinite strings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46
2.2.4 Equivalence relations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47
2.3 Some indecomposable modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
2.3.1 Finite-dimensional string modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48
2.3.2 Finite-dimensional band modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49
2.3.3 Infinite-dimensional string modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50
2.3.4 Infinite-dimensional band modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
2.4 The module category of a string algebra . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
2.4.1 Auslander-Reiten sequences for string algebras . . . . . . . . . . 54
2.4.2 Morphisms between string modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58
2.4.3 Morphisms between string and band modules . . . . . . . . . . 59
2.4.4 Morphisms between band modules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
2.4.5 Hammock posets and factorisations of graph maps . . . . . . . . 62
2.4.6 Hammock posets and morphisms between pure-injective modules 65
2.5 The Ziegler spectrum of a domestic string algebra . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
2.5.1 The transfinite radical and a lower bound for the Krull-Gabriel
dimension of a string algebra . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
3 The Cantor-Bendixson rank and Krull-Gabriel dimension of a do-
mestic string algebra 71
3.1 The Cantor-Bendixson rank of points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
3.1.1 The Cantor-Bendixson rank of N-string modules . . . . . . . . . 72
3.1.2 The Cantor-Bendixson rank of Z-string modules . . . . . . . . . 77
3.1.3 The Cantor-Bendixson rank of Prufer modules . . . . . . . . . . 79
3.1.4 The Cantor-Bendixson rank of adic modules . . . . . . . . . . . 81
3.1.5 The Cantor-Bendixson rank of generic modules . . . . . . . . . 84
3.2 The CB rank and KG dimension of a string algebra . . . . . . . . . . . 84
3
II The derived category 86
4 The bounded derived category of a gentle algebra 87
4.1 Homotopy strings and homotopy bands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
4.1.1 Homotopy strings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
4.1.2 Homotopy bands . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92
4.1.3 Resolvable homotopy strings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
4.1.4 Equivalence relations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94
4.2 Indecomposable complexes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
4.2.1 String complexes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95
4.2.2 Band complexes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97
5 Morphisms between indecomposable objects in the bounded derived
category of a gentle algebra 100
5.1 Morphisms between string and band complexes . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
5.1.1 The setup and some preliminary lemmas . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101
5.1.2 A basis in Cb,−(A-proj) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103
5.1.3 A basis in Kb,−(A-proj) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107
5.2 Morphisms between r-dimensional band complexes . . . . . . . . . . . 115
5.2.1 A basis in Cb,−(A-proj) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116
5.2.2 A basis in Kb,−(A-proj) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118
5.3 Homotopy category of a derived-discrete algebra . . . . . . . . . . . . . 124
5.3.1 A bound on the dimension of Hom(PV , PW ) . . . . . . . . . . . 127
5.3.2 The category when gldim Λ <∞ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 130
5.3.3 The category when gldim Λ =∞ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
6 The Ziegler spectrum of a compactly generated triangulated category138
6.1 Compactly generated triangulated categories . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138
6.2 The Ziegler spectrum of T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139
6.3 Homeomorphism between Zg(T) and Zg(Abs-Tc) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
6.4 Σ-pure-injective objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143
6.5 Localisation with respect to closed subsets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
4
7 The Ziegler spectrum of the homotopy category of a derived-discrete
algebra 145
7.1 Krull-Gabriel analysis of Coh(K) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
7.1.1 Simple functors in Coh(K) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 146
7.1.2 Simple functors in Coh(K)/ann(X0) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147
7.1.3 Simple functors in Coh(K)/ann(X1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 150
7.2 The Ziegler spectrum . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
7.2.1 Cantor-Bendixson Rank 0 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
7.2.2 Cantor-Bendixson Rank 1 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 151
7.2.3 Cantor-Bendixson Rank 2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152
7.2.4 Classification of indecomposable pure-injective complexes . . . . 152
8 Indecomposable objects in the homotopy category of a derived-discrete
algebra 153
8.1 Indecomposable objects when gldim Λ =∞ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 156
8.2 Indecomposable objects when gldim Λ <∞ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158
Bibliography 166
Word count 31,015
5
The University of Manchester
Rosanna LakingDoctor of PhilosophyString Algebras in Representation TheoryAugust 4, 2016
The work in this thesis is concerned with three subclasses of the string algebras:domestic string algebras, gentle algebras and derived-discrete algebras (of non-Dynkintype). The various questions we answer are linked by the theme of the Krull-Gabrieldimension of categories of functors.
We calculate the Cantor-Bendixson rank of the Ziegler spectrum of the category ofmodules over a domestic string algebra. Since there is no superdecomposable moduleover a domestic string algebra, this is also the value of the Krull-Gabriel dimensionof the category of finitely presented functors from the category of finitely presentedmodules to the category of abelian groups.
We also give a description of a basis for the spaces of homomorphisms between pairsof indecomposable complexes in the bounded derived category of a gentle algebra. Wethen use this basis to describe the Hom-hammocks involving (possibly infinite) stringobjects in the homotopy category of complexes of projective modules over a derived-discrete algebra.
Using this description, we prove that the Krull-Gabriel dimension of the categoryof coherent functors from a derived-discrete algebra (of non-Dynkin type) is equal to2. Since the Krull-Gabriel dimension is finite, it is equal to the Cantor-Bendixsonrank of the Ziegler spectrum of the homotopy category and we use this to identifythe points of the Ziegler spectrum. In particular, we prove that the indecomposablepure-injective complexes in the homotopy category are exactly the string complexes.
Finally, we prove that every indecomposable complex in the homotopy category ispure-injective, and hence is a string complex.
6
Declaration
The published paper constituting Chapter 5 was previ-
ously submitted by Kristin Krogh Arnesen in support of
an application for a doctoral degree at the Norwegian
University of Science and Technology in 2015. No other
portion of the work referred to in this thesis has been
submitted in support of an application for another de-
gree or qualification of this or any other university or
other institute of learning.
7
Copyright Statement
i. The author of this thesis (including any appendices and/or schedules to this thesis)
owns certain copyright or related rights in it (the “Copyright”) and s/he has given
The University of Manchester certain rights to use such Copyright, including for
administrative purposes.
ii. Copies of this thesis, either in full or in extracts and whether in hard or electronic
copy, may be made only in accordance with the Copyright, Designs and Patents
Act 1988 (as amended) and regulations issued under it or, where appropriate, in
accordance with licensing agreements which the University has from time to time.
This page must form part of any such copies made.
iii. The ownership of certain Copyright, patents, designs, trade marks and other intel-
lectual property (the “Intellectual Property”) and any reproductions of copyright
works in the thesis, for example graphs and tables (“Reproductions”), which may
be described in this thesis, may not be owned by the author and may be owned by
third parties. Such Intellectual Property and Reproductions cannot and must not
be made available for use without the prior written permission of the owner(s) of
the relevant Intellectual Property and/or Reproductions.
iv. Further information on the conditions under which disclosure, publication and com-
mercialisation of this thesis, the Copyright and any Intellectual Property and/or
Reproductions described in it may take place is available in the University IP Policy
(see http://documents.manchester.ac.uk/DocuInfo.aspx?DocID=487), in any rele-
vant Thesis restriction declarations deposited in the University Library, The Univer-
sity Library’s regulations (see http://www.manchester.ac.uk/library/aboutus/regul-
ations) and in The University’s Policy on Presentation of Theses.
8
Acknowledgements
First and foremost, I would like to thank my supervisor Mike Prest for all of the
interesting and helpful mathematical discussions, as well as for his constant advice
and support. Without the latter I would almost certainly not have completed even
the first year of my PhD.
Understanding mathematics can be challenging, but stimulating conversations with
like-minded mathematicians makes this challenge an extremely enjoyable and satisfy-
ing one. I have been lucky enough to have had many such conversations during my
time in Manchester and I would like to take this opportunity to thank those people
who have made that possible. In particular, I would like to thank all of Mike’s other
PhD students and postdocs (past and present): Amit, Sam, Mike, Isaac, Harry, Lorna
and David. I would also like to thank Inga, Alex, Tahel, Malte and Liz for all the
chats and fun office lunches.
By some happy coincidence, many of the projects I have worked on during my PhD
have been collaborative. Sharing the highs and lows of research with my collaborators
has been a fantastic experience and I would like to thank Gena, Mike, David and
Kristin for working with me.
My final word of thanks belongs to all the friends, family and loved-ones who have
helped me to balance my work with the rest of life!
9
Introduction
A unifying theme in this thesis is the interplay between a topological space known as
the Ziegler spectrum, whose points are particular indecomposable objects in a fixed
category C (e.g. a module category), and a corresponding category of functors. In
particular, we consider the category of finitely presented functors from a ‘generating’
subcategory G of C (e.g. the category of finitely presented modules) to the category of
abelian groups; we will refer to this as the functor category. On the face of it, there is
no reason to suppose that these two mathematical structures are related but, in fact,
it is very often the case that some aspect of the structure of one can be seen in the
structure of the other. The points of the Ziegler spectrum are isomorphism classes
of indecomposable pure-injective objects of C. Originally the topology was given in
terms of model theory, but it was later shown that the each closed set is given by the
intersection of the kernels of a (possibly infinite) set of objects in the functor category.
Moreover, the relative topology on a given closed set corresponds to some localisation
of the functor category and vice versa. Here we study this interplay for categories C
arising in the representation theory of the class of string algebras, as well as that of
two interesting subclasses: the gentle algebras and derived-discrete algebras. In these
cases, the similarities between the structure of the Ziegler spectrum and the structure
of the functor category are even stronger: the isolated points in any closed set are in
one-to-one correspondence with the simple objects in the related localisation of the
functor category. By exploiting this interaction, we are able to calculate the Cantor-
Bendixson rank of the Ziegler spectrum (which is given by iterated removal of isolated
points) both for the module category of a domestic string algebra and for the homotopy
category of complexes of projective modules over a derived-discrete algebra. In these
categories, the Cantor-Bendixson rank coincides with the Krull-Gabriel dimension of
the functor category (which is given by iterated localisation).
10
11
Despite the fact that we do not explicitly refer to any model theoretic notions in
this thesis, it is worth noting that many of the structures arising from the model theory
of modules are implicitly present in the work. We therefore take this opportunity to
give a sketch of how some of these model theoretic structures fit into the picture.
Since Ziegler’s landmark paper [60], the main object of study in the model theory of
modules has been the Ziegler spectrum and it is sometimes said to contain most of
the model theoretic information in the relevant category. For every object M , there
exists a direct sum N of indecomposable pure-injective objects that is elementarily
equivalent to M (i.e. M and N satisfy the same sentences in the language) so, in this
sense, the points of the spectrum relate to the elementary equivalence classes of the
category. Moreover, the closed sets in the topology are given by (possibly infinite)
sets of pairs of positive primitive (pp) formulas. When we consider modules over an
algebra (over an infinite field), it is a consequence of the Baur-Monk theorem [9, 37]
that these correspond exactly to theories in the language. In practice, one may study
the Ziegler spectrum via lattices of pp formulas (any interval in the lattice is defined
by one such pair of pp formulas). Indeed, in [36] we present the work contained in
Chapter 3 in terms of the lattice of pp formulas in one free variable. Since every pair of
pp formulas defines an object in the functor category (and vice versa), we have chosen
to present these arguments in the setting of the functor category; in fact, this was the
original approach of the author. The functor category approach to the model theory
is well-developed and this perspective has been extremely fruitful. We are thus able
to present the work in this thesis using only algebraic notions and choose to do so in
order to avoid unnecessary background requirements.
The functor category, and hence the Ziegler spectrum of a category C, are closely
related to the morphisms in the subcategory G of C. In the first part of the thesis we
take C to be R-Mod for a ring R (or, more generally, a small preadditive category)
and the subcategory G is the category R-mod of finitely presented modules. In the
second part, we take C to be a compactly generated category T and the subcategory
G is the triangulated subcategory Tc of compact objects. In both cases, the objects F
in the functor category are part of an exact sequence of the form
Hom(N,−)→ Hom(M,−)→ F → 0
where M and N are objects in G. By Yoneda’s lemma, the functor F is the cokernel
12
of a natural transformation Hom(f,−) : Hom(N,−)→ Hom(M,−) where f : M → N
is a morphism in G. Thus, studying the functor category and studying the morphisms
in G can be seen as equivalent tasks. Indeed, this is the perspective we take in the
forthcoming chapters. For example, in order to calculate the Krull-Gabriel dimension
in Chapter 3, we make heavy use of the well-understood basis for the vector space
HomA(M,N) where A is a string algebra and M and N are indecomposable finite-
dimensional A-modules. In the second half of the thesis we work in a triangulated
category T where Tc is equivalent to the bounded derived category Db(A-mod) of
a gentle algebra A. We wish to apply similar techniques to this category and so in
Chapter 5 we describe an explicit basis for HomDb(A-mod)(C,D) where C and D are
indecomposable complexes. Again, we then use the close relationship between the
functor category, the Ziegler spectrum and morphisms in Tc to describe the corre-
sponding Ziegler spectrum, Cantor-Bendixson rank and Krull-Gabriel dimension for a
special family of gentle algebras known as the derived-discrete algebras.
In general, the functor category is difficult to describe explicitly and so the idea
of the Krull-Gabriel dimension is that it enables us to compare functor categories; in
some sense the Krull-Gabriel dimension measures the complexity of the structure of
the functor category. The idea of the Cantor-Bendixson rank of a topological space is
similar; a rank is assigned to each point and this is a measurement of ‘how isolated’
this point is. In the examples we consider, the Krull-Gabriel dimension of the functor
category coincides with the Cantor-Bendixson rank of the Ziegler spectrum and so if we
can calculate one then we may calculate the other. We see examples of this idea going
in both directions. In Chapter 5, we combine the recent classification of the points of
the Ziegler spectrum of the module category of a domestic string algebra [48] with the
description of the morphisms in the category to calculate the Cantor-Bendixson rank.
This then allows us to deduce the value of the Krull-Gabriel dimension. Conversely,
the structure of the morphisms in the bounded derived category of a derived-discrete
algebra are well-understood (see, for example, [15]) and so we use this in Chapter 7 to
calculate the Krull-Gabriel dimension. We can then use this to identify the points of
the Ziegler spectrum and to calculate the Cantor-Bendixson rank.
The string algebras are an important class of tame algebras. Their representation
theory is highly combinatorial in nature, making it possible to answer many questions
13
for string algebras that are much more difficult to answer for general tame algebras. As
such, the class plays the role of a ‘test class’ for conjectures and, moreover, they enable
one to develop ones intuition for tame algebras in general via direct computation of
examples. The indecomposable finite-dimensional modules have been classified (see
[49, 23, 20, 16, 58]) and can be described by ‘strings’ and ‘bands’. Furthermore, Ringel
extends the definitions of string and band modules to define certain indecomposable
infinite-dimensional pure-injective modules [50] and, in the same paper, he conjectures
that, if the string algebra has domestic representation type, then the modules he lists
form a complete list of the points of the Ziegler spectrum. In a recent paper [48],
Prest and Puninski confirm this conjecture. This is the starting point for the work
contained in the first part of this thesis.
By definition, a string algebra is the path algebra of a quiver with relations that
satisfies certain conditions designed to restrict the structure of the indecomposable
projective modules. This definition is a slight specialisation of the definition of a special
biserial algebra, for which the restrictions on the quiver mean that all indecomposable
projective modules are biserial. In general, the combinatorics for string algebras is less
complicated than for special biserial algebras, and so we consider this smaller class for
the sake of the clarity of our arguments.
By adding further restrictions on the quiver one obtains the definition of a gentle
algebra. Gentle algebras were introduced in the context of determining the derived
equivalence classes of path algebras of quivers of type A and A [3, 4]. The derived
category of a gentle algebra is similar in nature to the module category of a string
algebra; the indecomposable complexes in the bounded derived category are described
by ‘homotopy strings’ and ‘homotopy bands’ [10]. As such, the gentle algebras form
an effective test class for the derived category in the same way that string algebras do
for the module category. For this reason, as well as to provide a stepping stone to the
results contained in Chapters 7 and 8, we develop the general theory of the derived
category of a gentle algebra by giving a combinatorial description of the morphisms in
the category; this can be found in Chapter 5.
Gentle algebras also arise in the classification of the derived equivalence classes
of the so-called derived-discrete algebras [13]. The definition of a discrete derived
category was given by Vossieck in [57]; the idea is that such a derived category is
14
somewhere between the derived category of a hereditary algebra of finite representation
type and the derived category of a hereditary algebra of infinite representation type.
It turns out that the representatives of the derived equivalence classes are of a specific
form (see Section 5.3) and, moreover, they are gentle. In Chapter 7 we describe the
Ziegler spectrum of these algebras. The case where the algebra is derived-discrete
and self-injective with infinite global dimension has been investigated by Zhe Han
in his PhD thesis [59]. He is able to show that every indecomposable object in the
homotopy category of such an algebra is pure-injective and can be described by an
infinite homotopy string. In Chapter 8 we are able to extend this result to arbitrary
derived-discrete algebras.
Summary of content
The content of this thesis is divided into two parts; the work in the first part takes place
in an abelian setting (specifically module categories, and more generally, categories
of functors) and the second part includes triangulated categories (derived categories
and homotopy categories), though the abelian setting continues to play a role. Both
sections include a significant amount of background material. We have chosen to
include this background explicitly in an attempt to produce a self-contained document,
as well as to fix the notation used in the subsequent proofs. Still, despite the extent
of the background given, we have assumed that the reader has some knowledge of the
representation theory of finite-dimensional algebras and basic category theory. In this
section we will outline the contents of the thesis and we will also give some indication
of the background we have assumed for each section.
Chapter 1 is an overview of the techniques we will use in later chapters; that is, the
functor category and the Ziegler spectrum. In this chapter we have assumed that the
reader has knowledge of basic category theory and, in particular, of abelian categories.
We begin by introducing the functor category and we give a detailed account of how
the structure of the lattice of subfunctors of a finitely presented functor relates to a
lattice of (pointed) morphisms. The calculation of the Krull-Gabriel dimension and
Cantor-Bendixson rank given in Chapter 3 will rely heavily on this description of
the finitely presented functors. We then go on to define the Ziegler spectrum and
15
describe an important example: the Ziegler spectrum of k[T, T−1]-Mod. Section 1.3
is a summary of the strong connections between the Ziegler spectrum and the functor
category. The end of Section 1.3 and Section 1.4 contains some open questions and
conjectures that we will later confirm for string algebras. Finally, in Section 1.5 we
define elementary duality; we will make use of this definition in Section 3.1.4 in which
we describe the elementary duals of all points of the Ziegler spectrum of a domestic
string algebra.
In Chapter 2 we give a summary of the relevant background on string algebras. In
this chapter we assume that the reader is familiar with the basics of representation
theory of finite-dimensional algebras, in particular path algebras of quivers with rela-
tions, as well as some Auslander-Reiten theory. We define all the points of the Ziegler
spectrum of a domestic string algebra (the finite-dimensional points are defined in
Sections 2.3.1 and 2.3.2 and the infinite-dimensional points are defined in Sections
2.3.3 and 2.3.4). In Section 2.4 we describe the Auslander-Reiten structure and the
morphisms between indecomposable modules. Finally, in Section 2.5, we summarise
what is known about the Ziegler spectrum of a domestic string algebra.
In Chapter 3 we calculate the Cantor-Bendixson rank of the Ziegler spectrum of a
domestic string algebra as well as the Krull-Gabriel dimension of the functor category.
The idea of the proof is that we combine the description of the morphisms in the
module category (see Section 2.4.5) with the description of subfunctors of finitely
presented functors (see Section 1.1.1) in order to calculate the Cantor-Bendixson rank
of each point of the Ziegler spectrum. Since the points are completely classified (see
Section 2.5) we may deduce the Cantor-Bendixson rank of the entire space, and we do
so in Section 3.2. Moreover, in light of the connections between the Ziegler spectrum
and the functor category (see Section 1.3.4), this is also the value of the Krull-Gabriel
dimension of the functor category.
In Chapter 4 we give the relevant background on the structure of the bounded
derived category of a gentle algebra. We assume the reader is familiar with the def-
initions of derived categories, homotopy categories and also with the basic theory of
triangulated categories. We also introduce some new notation for homotopy bands
and strings (we refer to this as the ‘unfolded diagram’ of a homotopy string or band);
this notation is extremely important in understanding our approach to the proofs in
16
Chapter 5.
In Chapter 5 we describe a basis for the morphisms between indecomposable ob-
jects in the bounded derived category of a gentle algebra. Section 5.1 deals with the
morphisms between string complexes and the band complexes that sit at the base of
homogeneous tubes in the Auslander-Reiten quiver. Section 5.2 then deals with the
remaining band modules. The approach in these two sections is the same: we first
establish a basis in the category of complexes of finite-dimensional projective modules
and then consider homotopy equivalences between basis elements. The final section
in Chapter 5 then applies our results to the homotopy category of a derived-discrete
algebra. This section also contains various results that are already known on structure
of the category; this structure is central to the arguments in Chapters 7 and 8.
The definitions and results analogous to those in Chapter 1 can be given for com-
pactly generated triangulated categories and in Chapter 6 we describe this setting.
In fact, in Section 6.3 we show that the definitions of purity in such a triangulated
category correspond to purity in a localisation of a functor category.
In Chapter 7 we consider the Ziegler spectrum and functor category associated
to the homotopy category of projective modules over a derived-discrete algebra. The
morphisms in the homotopy category are very well understood and the dimension of
the space of homomorphisms between two indecomposable compact objects is at most
two (see Section 5.3). Given the description of lattices of subfunctors (see Section
1.1.1) we use this to explicitly calculate the Krull-Gabriel dimension of the functor
category. Moreover, since there is a bijection between simple objects and points of the
Ziegler spectrum (see Section 1.3.4), we use this to describe the Ziegler spectrum of the
homotopy category and also to calculate the Cantor-Bendixson rank. This approach
is very similar to that of Chapter 3.
In the final chapter we extend a result from [59]; that is, we prove that every inde-
composable complex in the homotopy category of projective modules over a derived-
discrete algebra is pure-injective. We deal with the infinite and finite global dimension
cases separately. In Section 8.1 we consider the case where the algebra has infinite
global dimension and we prove that every indecomposable object is Σ-pure-injective;
we do this by considering the definable subcategory generated by an arbitrary in-
decomposable object and showing that it is contained in the definable subcategory
17
generated by a Σ-pure-injective object. In Section 8.2 we consider the case where the
algebra has finite global dimension. In this case we explicitly use the structure of cer-
tain representable functors to show that an arbitrary indecomposable complex in the
homotopy category must in fact be isomorphic to an indecomposable pure-injective
object contained in the definable subcategory it generates.
Summary of my contribution to joint work
The work contained in this thesis falls into three distinct collaborative projects, each
of which has been written up into one of the following papers: [36], [1], [2]. This work
was carried out via various styles of collaboration and this has influenced how the work
from each paper is presented. In this section I will outline my contribution to each
project, as well as how far its presentation here deviates from that of the corresponding
paper.
The paper [36] is joint with Mike Prest and Gena Puninski and the work contained
in this paper can be found in Chapter 3. With the exception of the final details, I
produced these results independently of my coauthors. On the one hand, Prest and
Puninski described neighbourhood bases for points of the Ziegler spectrum in terms
of pp formulas and used them to calculate the Cantor-Bendixson rank. On the other
hand, I used arguments based on the structure of the morphisms in the category to
identify simple functors and isolated points and thus calculate the Cantor-Bendixson
rank. During Puninski’s visit to Manchester in 2014, it came to light that we had
the same results (and almost the same arguments, but different lexicons). Following
several discussions, during which we fine-tuned our arguments, we decided to publish
the results together. For the paper we decided to present the results in terms of pp
formulas; I have rewritten them for this thesis in the way I originally proved them,
that is, in terms of morphism between finite-dimensional modules.
The work in [1] is joint with Kristin Arnesen and David Pauksztello and can be
found in Chapter 5. This work was carried out in close collaboration during Arnesen’s
visit to Manchester in April 2014, as well as, a reciprocal visit to Trondheim in June
2014. All results contained in this chapter were worked out with equal contributions
from each of us. I have reworded many of the arguments for this thesis but the content
18
is the same; I hope to have made some of the exposition clearer in this reworking. In
particular, the presentation of the work in Section 5.2 is substantially different from the
paper and I have used the term ‘maximal graph homotopy’ rather than ‘quasi-graph
map’.
Finally, the paper [2] is joint with Kristin Arnesen, David Pauksztello and Mike
Prest. This work is divided between Chapters 7 and 8. The project began with detailed
discussions between all four authors during Arnesen’s second visit to Manchester in
October 2014 where the main ideas were established. We then continued to work on
the details of the proofs both independently and in various subsets of the authors.
The work contained in Chapter 7 was discussed during Arnesen’s visit and, following
this, I worked out the details and wrote them up for the paper. For this reason, the
exposition of this section is almost identical to what is contained in the paper. The
main ideas for the proofs in Chapter 8 were due to Prest but the details required a lot
of work and this was done, in close collaboration, by myself, Pauksztello and Prest.
Moreover, the write up was carried out jointly by myself and Pauksztello and so the
content of Chapter 8 does not deviate far from the final section of [2].
Part I
The module category
19
Chapter 1
The functor category and Ziegler
spectrum
In this first chapter, we will introduce a setting that has its origins in the model
theoretic approach to representation theory. As the theory has developed, it has
became apparent that almost all of the definitions and results can be stated without
reference to the usual model theoretic notions, such as formulas and theories, since
these structures can be understood algebraically by viewing them as structures within
certain categories of functors. The results in this thesis are presented entirely in terms
of functor categories and localisation but could have just as easily been written entirely
in terms of lattices of pp formulas. This choice was made arbitrarily and is not intended
to reflect any preference for one approach or the other; greater insight can be achieved
by understanding both viewpoints, however sticking to one setting rather than two
should make the exposition clearer.
We will require a more general notion of module than is usually given; that is, we
will consider “modules over rings with many objects”. By this we mean a covariant
functor M : R → Ab where R is a skeletally small preadditive category and Ab is
the category of abelian groups. Such a functor is a right R-module. Similarly, a
contravariant functorN : R → Ab (or, equivalently, a covariant functorN : Rop → Ab)
is a right R-module.
Throughout this chapter the notation R will refer to an arbitrary skeletally small
additive category. Let R-Mod denote the category of left R-modules and let R-mod
denote the full subcategory of finitely presented modules. Let Mod-R and mod-R
20
21
denote the analogous categories of right R-modules.
Remark 1.0.1. We will make statements for the category of left R-modules. Since
Mod-R ' Rop-Mod, all statements about categories of left R-modules will apply
equally well to categories of right R-modules and vice versa.
Example 1.0.2. When R has a single object ∗ the endomorphisms R = End(∗) form
a ring with addition coming from the preadditive structure and multiplication coming
from composition of morphisms. In this case, right and left R-modules are R-modules
in the usual sense.
We begin by noting some properties of the category R-Mod that will be important
in later proofs. For each module X in R-Mod, consider the associated (covariant)
representable functor
Hom(X,−) : R-mod→ Ab.
We will denote this functor by (X,−) and, for each f : X → Y in R-Mod, we denote
the natural transformation Hom(f,−) : (Y,−)→ (X,−) by (f,−).
Similarly, the (contravariant) representable functor Hom(−, X) will be de-
noted (−, X) and the natural transformation Hom(−, f) : (−, X) → (−, Y ) will be
denoted (−, f).
We do not give the definitions for finitely presented and finitely generated for a
general category here (see, for example, [44, App. E]). The definition for a functor
category is given below. If R = R is a ring (see Example 1.0.2 above), then a module
M in R-Mod is finitely generated if there is an exact sequence Rn → M → 0 for
some n ∈ N and finitely presented if there is an exact sequence Rm → Rn →M → 0
for some n,m ∈ N.
A category C is locally finitely presented if the full subcategory Cfp of finitely
presented objects is skeletally small, C is complete (i.e. has products and kernels) and
every object in C is a direct limit of a directed system of objects from Cfp.
Theorem 1.0.3 (see, for example, [40, Thm. 3.4.2] or [44, Ex. E.1.20]). For any small
preadditive category R, the category R-Mod is abelian and locally finitely presented.
It is therefore also Grothendieck.
22 CHAPTER 1. THE FUNCTOR CATEGORY AND ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
An object M in a category C is coherent if every finitely generated subobject is
finitely presented. Then C is locally coherent if the full subcategory Ccoh of coherent
objects is skeletally small and every object in C is a direct limit of a directed system
of objects from Ccoh. The local coherence of R-Mod depends on R.
Proposition 1.0.4 ([51, Prop. 2.2]). Let C be a locally finitely presented abelian cat-
egory. Then C is locally coherent if and only if Cfp is an abelian subcategory of C. In
particular, if R = R is a ring, then R-Mod is locally coherent if and only if R is a
coherent ring.
1.1 The functor category
In this section we will consider both the category (R-mod,Ab) of functors fromR-mod
to Ab and its full subcategory (R-mod,Ab)fp
of finitely presented functors. We will
focus of the structure of (R-mod,Ab)fp
and, in particular, the relationship between the
subfunctors of finitely presented functors and the morphisms inR-mod. Finally we will
define extensions of the objects in (R-mod,Ab)fp
to functors on R-Mod; these functors
are central in the definition of the topology on the Ziegler spectrum, a topological space
that will be introduced in the next section.
Since R-mod is a small preadditive category, we may treat (R-mod,Ab) as a mod-
ule category. For example, we may apply Theorem 1.0.3 to obtain that (R-mod,Ab)
is locally finitely presented and abelian. Moreover, every finitely presented object is
coherent (see [44, Cor. 10.2.3]) and so (R-mod,Ab) is also locally coherent. It follows
from Proposition 1.0.4 that (R-mod,Ab)fp
is abelian.
1.1.1 The category of finitely presented functors
It is well-known that the representable functors are exactly the finitely generated pro-
jective objects in (R-mod,Ab). So every finitely presented functor F has a presentation
by representable functors, and this will provide us with an explicit understanding of
the structure of the lattice of finitely presented subfunctors of F and also a direct link
with the morphisms in R-mod.
A functor F in (R-mod,Ab) is finitely presented if there exists an exact sequence
1.1. THE FUNCTOR CATEGORY 23
of functors
(Y,−)τ→ (X,−)→ F → 0
where X, Y are objects in R-mod. By Yoneda’s lemma τ = (f,−) for some f : X → Y
in R-mod. Let im(f,−) denote the image of (f,−) in (X,−). That is, for all modules
M in R-mod, we have im(f,M) = {hf | h : Y →M}. Thus F ∼= (X,−)/ im(f,−).
Let X be a module in R-mod. If f : X → M and g : X → N are morphisms in
R-mod, then let f ≥ g if there is some h : M → N such that g = hf .
Xf //
g��
M
h~~N
Then f ∼ g if and only if f ≥ g and g ≥ f .
Remark 1.1.1. The set of equivalence classes LX of morphisms starting at X is a
modular lattice with f ∨ g =[fg
]: X → Y ⊕ Z and f ∧ g is the pushout of f and g.
The proof of this can be found in [44, Lem. 3.1.2].
If F is an object (R-mod,Ab)fp
, then let L(F ) denote its (modular) lattice of
subobjects in (R-mod,Ab)fp
.
Lemma 1.1.2 ([44, Cor. 3.1.5]). Let X be a module in R-mod. Then
LX ∼= L((X,−))
where the morphism of lattices is given by f 7→ im(f,−).
For each f : X → Y , let Lf denote the interval in LX between im(f,−) and
im(1X ,−) = (X,−)
Corollary 1.1.3. Let F = (X,−)/ im(f,−) be a functor in (R-mod,Ab)fp
. Then
Lf ∼= L(F )
and the morphism is given by g 7→ im(g,−)/ im(f,−).
We will use the following easy lemmas in several places in later chapters; similar
results can be found in [47].
24 CHAPTER 1. THE FUNCTOR CATEGORY AND ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
Lemma 1.1.4. Let F = (X,−)/ im(f,−) be a functor in (R-mod,Ab)fp
and suppose
G is a non-zero finitely presented subfunctor of F , then G = im([ gf
],−)/ im(f,−) for
some g ≥ f in LX .
Proof. By Corollary 1.1.3, G = im(g,−)/ im(f,−) for some g ≥ f . It suffices to
show that g ∼[ gf
]. This is clear since f = hg for some h so g = [ 1 0 ]
[ gf
]and[ g
f
]= [ 1
h ] g.
Lemma 1.1.5. If g =n∑i=1
gi with f ≥ g1 in LX , then
im([ gf
],−) = im
([n∑i=2
gi
f
],−).
Proof. By Lemma 1.1.2, it suffices to show that[ gf
]∼[
n∑i=2
gi
f
]. Since g1 = hf for
some h, we have [ 1 h0 1 ]
[n∑i=2
gi
f
]=[ gf
]and [ 1 −h
0 1 ][ gf
]=
[n∑i=2
gi
f
].
Lemma 1.1.6. Suppose g =
[ g1...gn
]: M →
n⊕i=1
Ni and g1 ≥ gi for all 1 ≤ i ≤ n. Then
im(g,−) = im(g1,−).
Proof. By Lemma 1.1.2, it suffices to show that g ∼ g1. This is clear since we have
[ 1 0 ··· 0 ] g = g1 so g ≥ g1. For the other inequality, note that, since g1 ≥ gi, there
exists some fi such that gi = fig1 for each 1 ≤ i ≤ n. Then
[f1...fn
]g1 = g and so g1 ≥ g
as required.
1.1.2 Extensions of functors along direct limits
For every functor F in (R-mod,Ab) there is a unique extension of F to a functor from
R-Mod to Ab which commutes with direct limits. If M is a module in R-Mod, then,
as R-Mod is locally finitely presented, M = lim−→Mi for some directed system (Mi)i∈I
of finitely presented modules. We then define F (M) := lim−→F (Mi). If F is finitely
presented, then the extension of F to R-Mod will be referred to as a pp functor.
In order to avoid cumbersome notation, we will often write F both for a functor in
(R-mod,Ab) and its extension to R-Mod.
Such functors can be characterised by the properties in the following proposition.
Proposition 1.1.7. Let R be a small preadditive category and let F : R-Mod→ Ab.
Then the following conditions are equivalent:
1.2. THE ZIEGLER SPECTRUM 25
1. F is a pp functor.
2. F commutes with direct limits and products.
3. There exist M and N in R-mod such that
(M,−)→ (N,−)→ F → 0
is exact when evaluated at any module in R-Mod.
Proof. The fact that 1 and 3 are equivalent follows directly from the definitions, since
taking limits is right exact and (M,−) commutes with direct limits. The equivalence
between 1 and 2 is [19, Sec. 2.1].
1.2 The Ziegler spectrum
Next we introduce a topological space known as the Ziegler spectrum of R-Mod.
The space was originally introduced by M. Ziegler in his landmark paper [60] and the
definitions of purity as well as the topology were given in terms of pairs of pp formulas.
As we have already mentioned, subsequent work relating these definitions to objects
in the functor category allow us to define the Ziegler spectrum as it is presented here.
A monomorphism f : M → N in R-Mod is pure if the natural transformation
−⊗R f : −⊗RM → −⊗R N
is a monomorphism in (mod-R,Ab). A module L is pure-injective if it is injective
over all pure monomorphisms. That is, for every pure monomorphism f : M → N
and every morphism g : M → L, there exists a morphism h : N → L such that the
following diagram commutes.
Mf //
g��
N
h~~L
Equivalently, L is pure-injective if and only if − ⊗R L is an injective object in
(mod-R,Ab).
The Ziegler spectrum Zg(R-Mod) (which we will write as RZg when R = R is a
ring as in Example 1.0.2) is a topological space with points given by the isomorphism
26 CHAPTER 1. THE FUNCTOR CATEGORY AND ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
classes of indecomposable pure-injective modules in R-Mod. Sets of the form
(F ) := {M ∈ Zg(R-Mod) | F (M) 6= 0}
where F is a pp functor form a basis of (compact) open sets.
A definable subcategory of R-Mod is a full subcategory with objects given by
a set of the form
{M | Fi(M) = 0 for all i ∈ Φ}
where {Fi | i ∈ Φ} is a family of pp functors. For a set of objects X, consider the
functors FX = {F | F (M) = 0 for all M ∈ X}. Then the definable subcategory
generated by X is the full subcategory with objects
{N | F (N) = 0 for all F ∈ FX}
and is denoted 〈X〉. This is the smallest definable subcategory (with respect to in-
clusion) containing X. We use the notation 〈M〉 when X = {M} for some module
M .
The closed subsets of Zg(R-Mod) are exactly those of the form D ∩ Zg(R-Mod)
for a definable subcategory D. For each module M , we will refer to the closed subset
Supp(M) := 〈M〉 ∩ Zg(R-Mod) as the support of M .
Example 1.2.1 ([22, Sec. 5]). Let k be an algebraically closed field. In this example
we will describe the points of the Ziegler spectrum of k[T, T−1]-Mod. The modules
are representations of the quiver • Tyy
where the k-linear map is an automorphism.
Since k is algebraically closed, the finite-dimensional indecomposable representations
are of the form Mn,k = (kn, Jn,k) where
Jn,k =
k 1 0 . . . 0 0
0 k 1 . . . 0 0...
...... · · · ...
...
0 0 0 . . . k 1
0 0 0 . . . 0 k
is the n× n Jordan block associated to k ∈ k∗ and n ∈ N.
For each k ∈ k∗ there is a homogeneous tube in the Auslander-Reiten quiver of
k[T, T−1]-mod of the following form.
1.3. DIMENSIONS 27
M1,k
ι1 ,,M2,k
−ι2 ,,
π1ll M3,k
ι3 **
−π2ll · · ·
π3ll
where ιn : Mk,n →Mk,n+1 and πn : Mk,n+1 →Mk,n are given by the following matrices.
ιn =
0 0 0 . . . 0 0
1 0 0 . . . 0 0
0 1 0 . . . 0 0...
...... · · · ...
...
0 0 0 . . . 0 1
πn =
1 0 0 . . . 0 0 0
0 1 0 . . . 0 0 0...
...... · · · ...
......
0 0 0 . . . 0 1 0
Then the direct limit Mk,∞ = lim−→Mk,n of the {ιn}n∈N is known as the Prufer mod-
ule associated to k and is indecomposable and pure-injective. Similarly the inverse
limit Mk,−∞ = lim←−Mk,n of the {πn}n∈N is known as the adic module associated to
k and it is also indecomposable and pure-injective.
The modules
{Mk,i | i ∈ N ∪ {∞,−∞}, k ∈ k∗}
together with the generic module G = k(T ) comprise a complete list of the points of
Zg(k[T, T−1]-Mod).
1.3 Dimensions
In this section we introduce three notions of dimension: the Cantor-Bendixson rank
of a topological space, the Krull-Gabriel dimension of an abelian category and the
m-dimension of a lattice. The definition of each dimension takes a particular form:
a “collapsing” process is carried out iteratively on a mathematical structure and the
dimension measures when (or if) this process produces something trivial.
If we take the topological space to be Zg(R-Mod), the abelian category to be
(R-mod,Ab)fp
, and the lattice to be a lattice of finitely-presented subfunctors, then
the dimensions are very closely related (and in certain cases will coincide). We discuss
this relationship in Section 1.3.4 and in Section 1.3.5 we discuss a further connection
with localisations of (R-mod,Ab).
28 CHAPTER 1. THE FUNCTOR CATEGORY AND ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
Finally, in Section 1.3.6, we look at how the above relates to powers of certain
ideals in R-mod when R = R is an Artin algebra. In particular, we will consider
the Jacobson radical radR of R-mod. There is another notion of dimension here: the
iterative process is taking transfinite powers of the ideal radR and the process stops
when radαR = radα+1R for some α. The connection with the other dimensions is not so
clear in this case.
1.3.1 Cantor-Bendixson rank
Let T be a compact topological space. Define the first Cantor-Bendixson derivative
T ′ to be the closed subset of T consisting of the non-isolated points. The set T ′ is
a topological space with the subspace topology and may have new isolated points.
Define T (0) := T , T (α+1) := (T (α))′ for any ordinal α and T (λ) :=⋂β<λ T
(β) when λ is
a limit ordinal.
If a point p is isolated in T (α) for some α, then we say p has Cantor-Bendixson
rank α. In this case we write CB(p) = α. If p is not isolated in T (α) for any ordinal
α, then we say that the Cantor-Bendixson rank of p is undefined and this is denoted
CB(p) =∞.
Let T (∞) =⋂α T
(α). If T (∞) = ∅, then the Cantor-Bendixson rank of T is the
least ordinal β such that T (β+1) = ∅. This is denoted CB(T ) = β. If T (∞) 6= ∅, then we
say that the Cantor-Bendixson rank of T is undefined. This is denoted CB(T ) =∞.
Remark 1.3.1. 1. Since T is a set, we must have T (∞) = T (α) for some ordinal α.
2. If T (λ) = ∅ for some limit ordinal, then T (β) = ∅ for some β < λ. This follows
because T = (T (λ))c =⋃β<λ(T
(β))c and so, since T is compact, there is some
finite set β1, · · · , βn < λ such that T =n⋃i=1
(T (βi))c. So the intersection⋂ni=1 T
(βi)
is empty, that is T (βj) = ∅ where βi ≤ βj for all 1 ≤ i ≤ n.
3. If CB(T ) = β for some ordinal β, then the isolated points of T are dense in T .
Otherwise there is some open set ∅ 6= U ⊆ T containing no isolated points and
U ⊆ T (∞), a contradiction.
1.3. DIMENSIONS 29
1.3.2 Krull-Gabriel dimension
Let A be an abelian category. A Serre subcategory S of A is a full subcategory
such that for all exact sequences
0→ F → G→ H → 0
in A, we have that F,H ∈ S if and only if G ∈ S. We can define the (Serre)
localisation A/S of A by S to be the category with the same objects as A and for
F,G we have
HomA/S(F,G) := lim−→ HomA(F ′, G/G′)
where the direct limit is over all subobjects F ′ of F such that F/F ′ ∈ S and G′ of G
such that G′ ∈ S.
Given an abelian category A, let A0 denote the Serre subcategory generated by the
simple objects inA (that is, consisting of all finite length objects inA). If F ∈ A0, then
we say that F has Krull-Gabriel dimension 0. Then let Aα+1 be the Serre subcategory
generated by objects of A that become finite length or zero in A/Aα for any ordinal
α and Aλ :=⋃β<λAβ when λ is a limit ordinal. For an ordinal α, let qα : A → A/Aα
be the canonical localisation functor.
We say that F ∈ A has Krull-Gabriel dimension α + 1 if F ∈ Aα+1\Aα. This
is denoted KG(F ) = α if such an ordinal exists, otherwise we say the Krull-Gabriel
dimension of F is undefined and this is denoted KG(F ) =∞.
If Aα = A for some ordinal α, then we say that the Krull-Gabriel dimension
of A is the least such α. This is denoted KG(A) = α. If no such α exists, then we say
that the Krull-Gabriel dimension of A is undefined and we denote this KG(A) =∞.
1.3.3 m-dimension
Suppose L is a modular lattice with bottom and top elements. Then, for x, y ∈ L,
let x ∼ y if and only if there are only finite length chains between x ∧ y and x ∨ y.
This defines a congruence relation on L and so the equivalence classes L/∼ have a
modular lattice structure. Let L0 := L, for any ordinal α let Lα+1 = Lα/∼ and let
Lλ = lim−→ α<λLα for any limit ordinal λ. We define the m-dimension of L to be
the least ordinal α such that Lα+1 = 0 if such an ordinal exists. This is denoted
30 CHAPTER 1. THE FUNCTOR CATEGORY AND ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
mdim(L) = α. If no such α exists then we say that the m-dimension of L is undefined
and we write mdim(L) =∞.
Remark 1.3.2. If λ is a limit ordinal, then Lλ = 0 if and only if Lα = 0 for some
successor ordinal α < λ. To see this let πα : L → Lα be the canonical surjection of
lattices. Then if Iα = {x ∈ L | πα(x) = 0} for each ordinal α, then Iλ =⋃α<λ Iα.
Since Lα = 0 if and only if 1 ∈ Iα, the assertion follows.
The following proposition linking m-dimension and Krull-Gabriel dimension follows
directly from the definitions (or see, for example, [32, Lem. 1.1]). If F is an object in
an abelian category A, then let LA(F ) denote its (modular) lattice of subobjects in
A.
Proposition 1.3.3. Let A be an abelian catgory.
1. For all F ∈ A and every ordinal α, we have LA/Aα(qα(F )) ∼= LA(F )α.
2. For all non-zero F ∈ A, the m-dimension of LA(F ) is α+ 1 if and only if qα(F )
is non-zero and has finite length in A/Aα (the m-dimension will not be a limit
ordinal, see Remark 1.3.2). In particular, we have KG(F ) = mdim(LA(F )).
We will also need the following characterisation of when Krull-Gabriel dimension
is defined.
Proposition 1.3.4. The Krull-Gabriel dimension of A is defined if and only if for
each F ∈ A no subset of LA(F ) forms a densely ordered chain.
1.3.4 Fundamental bijections
Next we outline some correspondences that exist between subcategories of R-Mod
and subcategories of (R-mod,Ab)fp
. The close relationship between particular sub-
categories in these structures have led to some interesting questions, many of which
remain open and have given rise to some conjectures which we will state at the end of
the section and later in Section 1.4.
Let X be a set of objects or a full subcategory in R-Mod. Then we define the
annihilator of X to be the set
ann(X) := {F ∈ (R-mod,Ab)fp | F (M) = 0 for all M ∈ X}.
1.3. DIMENSIONS 31
Let S be a set of objects or a full subcategory in (R-mod,Ab)fp
. Then we define the
annihilator of S to be the set
ann(S) := {M ∈ R-Mod | F (M) = 0 for all F ∈ S}.
In both definitions F is identified with its unique extension to a pp functor.
The following bijections represent the deep connections between the functor cate-
gories, the module category and the Ziegler spectrum. The bijection between the sets
given in 1 and 2 is by definition; between the sets given in 1 and 3 is essentially [31,
Prop. 4.5].
Proposition 1.3.5. For a small preadditive category R there are bijections between
the following.
1. The definable subcategories of R-Mod.
2. The closed subsets of Zg(R-Mod).
3. The Serre subcategories of (R-mod,Ab)fp
.
The mutually inverse bijections are given as follows.
{The definable subcategories of R-Mod} ↔ {The closed subsets of Zg(R-Mod)}
X 7→ X ∩ Zg(R-Mod) 〈X〉 ←[ X.
{The definable subcategories of R-Mod} ↔ {The Serre subcategories of (R-mod,Ab)fp}
X 7→ ann(X ) ann(S)←[ S.
{The closed subsets of Zg(R-Mod} ↔ {The Serre subcategories of (R-mod,Ab)fp}
X 7→ ann(X) ann(S) ∩ Zg(R-Mod)←[ S.
Consider the Krull-Gabriel analysis described in Section 1.3.2 when A is taken to
be the functor category (R-mod,Ab)fp
. By Proposition 1.3.5, the Serre subcategory
Aα, for each ordinal α, corresponds to a definable subcategory Xα+1 := ann(Aα) and
a closed subset Xα+1 := Xα+1 ∩ Zg(R-Mod).
32 CHAPTER 1. THE FUNCTOR CATEGORY AND ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
Remark 1.3.6. In this remark we will give a full explanation of the fact that
Zg(R-Mod)(α+1) ⊆ Xα+1 for all successor ordinals α in the hope that it will eluci-
date the connections between the Ziegler spectrum and the functor category. We
will shorten the notation Zg(R-Mod) to Zg for the duration of the remark and let
A = (R-mod,Ab)fp
. We refer the reader to Sections 1.3.1 and 1.3.2 for the remaining
notation.
We argue inductively. For the base case, let α = 0. The Serre subcategory A0
of A consists of the finite length functors. Let M ∈ (Xα+1)c (where c refers to the
set theoretic complement of Xα+1). By definition, there must be some F ∈ A0 such
that F (M) 6= 0. Since F is finite length it has a finite length composition series and
at least one of the simple composition factors must be non-zero on M . Thus we may
assume that F is simple. But then M is isolated by F in Zg (see, for example, [44,
Cor. 5.3.3]), so M ∈ (Zg(1))c as claimed.
Next fix a successor ordinal α and suppose that for all successor ordinals β < α
we have that (Xβ+1)c ⊆ (Zg(β+1))c. Let M ∈ (Xα+1)c. Then there is a functor F ∈ A
such that F is finite length or zero in A/Aα−1. If F is zero in A/Aα−1, then there is
some successor β < α such that F ∈ Aβ. By our induction hypothesis, we have that
M ∈ (Xβ+1)c ⊆ (Zg(β+1))c ⊆ (Zg(α+1))c
as required. If F is finite length in A/Aα−1, then, as before, we may assume that F
is simple in A/Aα−1 and so M is isolated in Xα (again, by [44, Cor. 5.3.3]). By the
induction hypothesis, (Xα)c ⊆ (Zg(α))c and so either M is not in Zg(α) or M is isolated
in Zg(α). In either case, we may conclude that M ∈ (Zg(α+1))c as required.
It follows easily from this that there is a connection between the Krull-Gabriel
dimension of (R-mod,Ab)fp
and the Cantor-Bendixson rank of Zg(R-Mod). This
connection is first established in [60].
Proposition 1.3.7. Let R be a skeletally small preadditive category. If the Krull-
Gabriel dimension of A := (R-mod,Ab)fp
is defined, then the Cantor-Bendixson rank
of Zg(R-Mod) is defined.
Proof. For all successor ordinals α, we have Zg(R-Mod)(α+1) ⊆ ann(Aα)∩Zg(R-Mod).
If the Krull-Gabriel dimension of (R-mod,Ab)fp
is some successor ordinal α then
1.3. DIMENSIONS 33
Aα = (R-mod,Ab)fp
and ann(Aα) contains only the zero module. Thus we have
ann(Aα) ∩ Zg(R-Mod) = ∅ and so Zg(R-Mod)(α+1) = ∅. The Cantor-Bendixson rank
of Zg(R-Mod) is therefore less than or equal to α.
Open Question. If the Cantor-Bendixson rank of Zg(R-Mod) is defined, does it
follow that the Krull-Gabriel dimension of (R-mod,Ab)fp
is defined?
Clearly, if Zg(R-Mod)(α+1) = Xα+1 for all α, then the answer to the above question
is positive. An equivalent way of stating this is that for every isolated point M in
Zg(R-Mod)(α+1), there is a functor F whose image is simple in (R-mod,Ab)fp/Aα
such that (F ) ∩ Zg(R-Mod)(α+1) = {M}. So the simple functors at each stage of the
Krull-Gabriel analysis are in a one-to-one correspondence with the isolated points at
each stage of the Cantor-Bendixson analysis.
We say that the isolation condition holds for a closed subset Z of Zg(R-Mod)
(considered as a topological space with the relative topology) if the following is satis-
fied.
(IC) For every closed subset X of Z and every isolated point M in X there is a functor
F whose image is simple in (R-mod,Ab)fp/ann(X) such that (F ) ∩X = {M}.
Proposition 1.3.8 ([41, Thm. 10.19] or [60, Thm. 8.6]). Let R be a small preadditive
category and suppose the (IC) holds for a closed subset Z of Zg(R-Mod). Then the
Krull-Gabriel dimension of F = (R-mod,Ab)fp/ann(Z) is equal to α if and only if the
Cantor-Bendixson rank of Z is equal to α.
Moreover, there is a bijective correspondence
{M ∈ Z | CB(M) = α} ←→ {F ∈ F/Fα | F is simple}
where Fα is the Serre subcategory defined at the αth stage of the Krull-Gabriel analysis.
There are certain situations where (IC) is known to hold and we will use the following
in later sections.
Proposition 1.3.9 ([41, Sec. 10.16]). Let Z be a closed subset of Zg(R-Mod). If
the Krull-Gabriel dimension of (R-mod,Ab)fp/ann(Z) is defined, then the isolation
condition holds for Z.
34 CHAPTER 1. THE FUNCTOR CATEGORY AND ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
A pure-injective module is said to be superdecomposable if it has no (non-zero)
indecomposable summands.
Proposition 1.3.10 ([60]). If there is no superdecomposable pure-injective module
over a ring R, then the isolation condition holds for RZg.
Open Question. For which rings R does the Isolation Condition hold for RZg? Does
the isolation condition hold for the Ziegler spectrum of every ring R?
1.3.5 Localisation with respect to a hereditary torsion pair
Here we summarise some of the relevant definitions and results on torsion-theoretic
localisation that will be used in later sections; we refer the reader to [44, Ch. 11] for
a more detailed account. Throughout this section we take C to be a Grothendieck
abelian category.
Localisation takes place with respect to a hereditary torsion pair (T ,F) in C. The
idea is that the objects in T are “torsion” and will become zero in the localisation,
while the objects in F are “torsion-free” and the injective cogenerators of this class
will be unchanged in the localisation.
A subclass T of the objects in C is a torsion class if it is closed under epimorphic
images, extensions and arbitrary direct sums. It is hereditary if it is also closed
under subobjects in C. Similarly, we say that a subclass F of the objects in C is a
tosion-free class if it is closed under subobjects, extensions and arbitrary products.
Such a class is hereditary if it is also closed under taking injective hulls.
For any torsion class T , the class
T ⊥ := {B ∈ C | (A,B) = 0 for all A ∈ T }
is a torsion-free class. Similarly, for any torsion-free class F , the class
⊥F := {A ∈ C | (A,B) = 0 for all B ∈ F}
is a torsion class. Moreover T = ⊥(T ⊥) and F = (⊥F)⊥. Thus, any pair (T ,F) of
subclasses with T = ⊥F a torsion class (or equivalently with F = T ⊥ a torsion-free
class) is called a torsion pair. For any (T ,F), the torsion class T is hereditary if and
only if the torsion-free class F is hereditary; in this case we call (T ,F) a hereditary
torsion pair.
1.3. DIMENSIONS 35
Associated to any hereditary torsion pair (T ,F) there is a left exact subfunctor t
of the identity functor on C. We define this functor on an object C to be
tC :=∑{D | D is a subobject of C and D ∈ T }.
That is, tC is the largest torsion subobject of C. The action of t on morphisms is
restriction/corestriction.
Remark 1.3.11. Each of T , F and t completely determine the others (see [44, 11.1.1]).
In particular, F = {C | tC = 0} and T = {C | tC = C}.
From the above data we define the localisation C/T of the category C at the
torsion pair (T ,F): for an object C in C define
qt(C) := π−1(t(E(C ′)/C ′))
where C ′ := C/tC, E(C ′) denotes the injective hull of C ′ and π is the cokernel of the
canonical embedding of C ′ into E(C ′). For the objects in C/T , we take the collection
of objects qt(C) (as C runs over objects of C) and we take the obvious morphisms
induced by the definition of the objects.
Remark 1.3.12. Clearly qt : C → C/T defines a functor. We refer to qt as the local-
isation functor and we note the following properties:
1. The canonical embedding it : C/T → C is a right adjoint to qt.
2. If E is a torsion-free injective object then E ∼= itqt(E).
3. If D is a subobject of C, then C/D ∈ T if and only if qt(D) = qt(C). In this
case we say that D is T -dense in C.
Given a class of injective objects E in C we say that a torsion pair (T ,F) is
cogenerated by E if T = {C | (C,E) = 0 for all E ∈ E}; in this case we will denote
the torsion pair by (TE ,FE). Since E is a class of injective objects, T is a hereditary
torsion class. The torsion-free class F consists of objects cogenerated by E , that is, F
contains those objects of C which embed in an arbitrary product of copies of objects
in E .
We will be interested in hereditary torsion theories corresponding to definable
subcategories and these will be those of finite type, meaning t commutes with direct
limits. We note the following property of such torsion theories:
36 CHAPTER 1. THE FUNCTOR CATEGORY AND ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
Proposition 1.3.13. [44, 11.1.29] Let C be a locally finitely presented abelian category
and suppose that (T ,F) is a hereditary torsion pair of finite type on C. Then (T ,F)
is cogenerated by the set of indecomposable injective objects in F .
We will be concerned with localisation in functor categories and we note that
R-Mod is locally coherent. The following result links the notions of localisation at a
Serre subcategory and at a torsion pair in this setting. If C is a locally coherent abelian
category, let C fpdenote the full subcategory of finitely presented objects. Moreover,
given S ⊆ C then let−→S denote the full subcategory of C containing all objects lim−→i
Ai
with Ai ∈ S.
Theorem 1.3.14 ([26],[30]). Let C be a locally coherent abelian category.
1. There is a bijective correspondence between Serre subcategories of C fpand hered-
itary torsion theories of finite type in C. The correspondence is given by
S 7→(−→S ,−→S ⊥)
and (T ,F) 7→ T ∩ C fp
.
2. The image of the restriction of qt : C → C/T to C fp(where t is the torsion
functor associated to (T , T ⊥)) is the same as the localisation of C fpat the Serre
subcategory T ∩ C fp.
Remark 1.3.15. By Theorem 1.3.14, the hereditary torsion pairs of finite type in
(R-mod,Ab) are also in bijection with the sets in Proposition 1.3.4.
1.3.6 Artin algebras and fp idempotent ideals
When R is an Artin algebra, there are also correspondences between the sets listed
in Proposition 1.3.4 and certain ideals of morphisms in R-mod. Let I be an ideal in
R-mod and define the annihilator of I to be
ann(I) = {F ∈ (R-mod,Ab)fp | F (f) = 0 for all f ∈ I}.
Then we say that I is fp-idempotent if ann(I) is closed under extensions. Note that
an ideal J in R-mod is idempotent if and only if the class of functors in (R-mod,Ab)
vanishing on J is closed under extensions; an idempotent ideal is fp-idempotent but
1.3. DIMENSIONS 37
the converse is not true in general. For a set X or a full subcategory of R-Mod we
define the ideal [X] of morphisms in R-mod that factor through a module in add(X).
The bijections below are due to Krause; Prest refined the result for closed subsets
by showing that [X ] = [X ∩ Zg(R-Mod)]. Indeed, for any subset Z that is dense in
X ∩ Zg(R-Mod), we have [X ] = [Z].
Proposition 1.3.16 ([34, 43]). Let R be an Artin algebra. Then the fp-idempotent
ideals in R-mod are also in bijection with the sets listed in Proposition 1.3.5. The
relevant mutually inverse bijections are as follows.
{Definable subcategories of R-Mod} ↔ {Fp-idempotent ideals of R-mod}
X 7→ [X ] {M ∈ R-Mod | F (M) = 0 for all F ∈ ann(I)} ←[ I.
{Closed subsets of Zg(R-Mod)} ↔ {Fp-idempotent ideals of R-mod}
X 7→ [X] {M ∈ Zg(R-Mod) | F (M) = 0 for all F ∈ ann(I)} ←[ I.
{Serre subcategories of (R-mod,Ab)fp} ↔ {Fp-idempotent ideals of R-mod}
S 7→ {f ∈ R-mod | F (f) = 0 for all F ∈ S} ann(I)←[ I.
In [34], Krause uses the above correspondences to connect the transfinite powers of
the Jacobson radical of R-mod with the Serre subcategories arising in the Krull-Gabriel
analysis of (R-mod,Ab)fp
.
First we define what we mean by the transfinite powers of an ideal. Let I be an
ideal in R-mod. Then the finite powers of I are defined in the usual way:
In := {m∑i=1
fin . . . fi1 | fij ∈ I and m < ω}.
Then for any limit ordinal λ let Iλ =⋂β<λ Iβ and for any ordinal α := λ + n
where λ is a limit ordinal and n < ω let Iα := (Iλ)n+1. We refer to the ideals Iα for
ordinals α as the transfinite powers of I. Also let I∞ :=⋂α Iα.
The notation in the following comes from Sections 1.3.1, 1.3.2 and 1.3.4. If R is
an Artin algebra and M,N are indecomposable finite-dimensional R-modules, then
38 CHAPTER 1. THE FUNCTOR CATEGORY AND ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
define radR(M,N) to be the set of non-isomorphisms from M to N . Then radR is the
ideal in mod-R generated by the union⋃M,N
radR(M,N) where M and N range over
all indecomposable finite-dimensional R-modules.
Proposition 1.3.17 ([34, Thm. 8.12] ). Let R be an Artin algebra and α a successor
ordinal. Then
radωαR ⊆ {f ∈ R-mod | F (f) = 0 for all F ∈ Sα−1} = [Xα].
Corollary 1.3.18. Suppose the Cantor-Bendixson rank of Zg(R-Mod) is defined for
an Artin algebra R. For each successor ordinal α, every element of radωαR factors
through a finite direct sum of indecomposable pure injective modules with Cantor-
Bendixson rank equal to α.
Proof. Since the Cantor-Bendixson rank is defined, the isolation condition holds. This
means that Xα = Zg(α) where this denotes the closed subset of Zg(R-Mod) containing
points with Cantor-Bendixson rank greater than or equal to α. The result follows
immediately from this since, in any topological space where the Cantor-Bendixson
rank is defined, the isolated points in the space are dense (see, for example, [44,
Lem. 5.3.57]).
Corollary 1.3.19 ([34, Cor. 8.4]). If R is an Artin algebra with Krull-Gabriel dimen-
sion equal to α, then radωα+nR = 0 for some n ∈ N.
Open Question. If radωα+nR = 0 for some ordinal α, does it follow that the Krull-
Gabriel dimension of (R-mod,Ab)fp
is less than or equal to α?
1.4 Representation type
We saw in the previous section that there are many notions of dimension that measure
the complexity of structures relating to the category R-mod. When R = R is a finite-
dimensional k-algebra, the representation type of R is considered to be an indicator of
the complexity of R-mod. Accordingly, there appears to be some connection between
representation type and the notions of dimension discussed in the previous section.
In this section we outline what is known, as well as some conjectures that make this
1.4. REPRESENTATION TYPE 39
connection more precise. Later in the thesis we will prove that these conjectures hold
for string algebras.
If R and S are finite-dimensional k-algebras, then a functor F : R-Mod→ S-Mod
is a representation embedding if it is a k-linear, exact functor that reflects isomor-
phism and preserves direct sums, direct products and indecomposability.
Let A be a finite-dimensional algebra over a field k. Then A has wild represen-
tation type if there is a representation embedding from k〈X, Y 〉-Mod to A-Mod.
We define a one-parameter family of dimension n to be a family of finite-
dimensional R-modules
FB = {B ⊗k[T ] S | S is a simple left k[T ]-module }
where B is an (A,k[T ])-bimodule which is free of rank n over k[T ]. Then A has
tame representation type if, for every n ≥ 1, there exist one-parameter families
FB1 , . . . ,FBm of dimension n such that all but finitely many of the n-dimensional
A-modules are contained in⋃mi=1FBi .
The following is the famous Tame and Wild Theorem, first proved by Drozd in [21]
but strengthened using different methods in [17].
Theorem 1.4.1. [17, 21] Let A be a finite-dimensional algebra. Then A has tame or
wild representation type but not both.
The class of tame algebras can be further sub-divided. Firstly, we say that an alge-
bra A has finite representation type if there are only finitely many indecomposable
finite-dimensional A-modules up to isomorphism.
Proposition 1.4.2. [7, 6] Let A be an finite-dimensional algebra over a field k. Then
the following are equivalent.
1. The algebra A has finite representation type.
2. The Krull-Gabriel dimension of (A-mod,Ab)fp
is zero.
3. The ideal radωA = 0.
4. The Cantor-Bendixson rank of ZgA is zero.
40 CHAPTER 1. THE FUNCTOR CATEGORY AND ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
Proposition 1.4.3. [34] Let A be a finite-dimensional algebra. If A has wild repre-
sentation type, then rad∞A 6= 0 and the Krull-Gabriel dimension of (A-mod,Ab)fp
is
undefined.
Following these results, it is natural to ask whether the various dimensions we
have defined detect the dividing line between tame and wild. This is in fact not the
case, indeed, non-domestic string algebras are examples of tame algebras where the
Krull-Gabriel dimension of (A-mod,Ab)fp
and the Cantor-Bendixson rank of AZg are
undefined and also rad∞A 6= 0.
It is conjectured that the dimensions may determine whether a tame algebra is
domestic or non-domestic. Let µ(n) the number of one parameter families required to
cover almost all of the modules of dimension n. Then if A is a tame algebra such that
there exists some µ such that µ(n) < µ for all n ≥ 1, then we say that A has (tame)
domestic representation type.
Conjecture 1.4.4 ([44, Conj. 9.1.15]). Let A be a finite-dimensional algebra. Then
the following are equivalent.
1. The algebra A has domestic representation type.
2. The Krull-Gabriel dimension of (A-mod,Ab)fp
is defined.
3. The Krull-Gabriel dimension of (A-mod,Ab)fp
is finite.
Conjecture 1.4.5 ([44, Conj. 9.1.16]). Let A be a finite-dimensional algebra. Then
the following are equivalent.
1. The algebra A has domestic representation type.
2. The ideal rad∞A = 0.
3. The ideal radω2
A = 0.
In [53] Schroer makes a more precise conjecture of what the connection between
Krull-Gabriel dimension and the transfinite powers of the radical might be.
Conjecture 1.4.6. Let n ≥ 2 and let A be a finite-dimensional algebra. Then the
Krull-Gabriel dimension of (A-mod,Ab)fp
is equal to n if and only if radω(n−1)A 6= 0
and radωnA = 0.
1.5. ELEMENTARY DUALITY 41
These conjectures have been confirmed for cycle-finite algebras [56] and in Chapter
3 we will show that this also holds for string algebras.
1.5 Elementary duality
Let R be a ring. We begin by introducing a functor that will turn out to be a duality
between (R-mod,Ab)fp
and (mod-R,Ab)fp
. It was first introduced in [24] and also
in [8]. Let F be in (R-mod,Ab)fp
, then dF is the functor in (mod-R,Ab) defined as
follows.
• For every module A in mod-R, let dF (A) := (F,A⊗−).
• For every morphisms g : A→ B in mod-R, let dF (g) : (F,A⊗−)→ (F,B ⊗−)
be given by τ 7→ (g ⊗−)τ .
Let σ : F → G be a morphism in (R-mod,Ab)fp
. Then dσ : dG → dF maps τ in
(G,M ⊗−) to τσ in (F,M ⊗−) for each M in mod-R.
Theorem 1.5.1 (See [44, Thm. 10.3.4]). Let F be a functor in (R-mod,Ab)fp
, then dF
is finitely presented in (mod-R,Ab). Moreover, d : ((R-mod,Ab)fp
)op → (mod-R,Ab)
fp
is an equivalence of categories.
Let N ∈ ZgR. We say that N is reflexive if there is a unique point D(N) ∈ RZg
such that, for every F in (R-mod,Ab)fp
, we have N ∈ (F ) if and only in D(N) ∈ (dF ).
Refer to D(N) as the elementary dual of N .
Theorem 1.5.2 ([25, Thm. 4.10]). Let X be a closed subset of Zg(R-Mod) and N ∈
Zg(R-Mod) such that N is isolated in X by a functor F such that the image of F in
(R-mod,Ab)fp/ann(X) is simple. Then N is reflexive.
Corollary 1.5.3. If every point of X is reflexive, then X and
D(X) := {D(M) |M ∈ X}
are homeomorphic via elementary duality.
Remark 1.5.4. If R is a finite-dimensional algebra over a field k, then every finite-
dimensional module M is isolated in Zg(R-Mod) by a simple functor and D(M) is
equal to the k-dual given by Homk(M,k). Denote Homk(M,k) by M∗.
42 CHAPTER 1. THE FUNCTOR CATEGORY AND ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
The following is true for any ring with a suitable dual replacing (−)∗, see [44,
Sec. 1.3.3].
Theorem 1.5.5 ([61, Prop. 3]). Let R be a finite-dimensional algebra over a field k
and let M be a left R-module. Then for every F ∈ (R-mod,Ab)fp
F (M) = 0 if and only if dF (M∗) = 0.
Corollary 1.5.6. Let R be a finite-dimensional algebra. If M ∈ RZg and M∗ ∈ ZgR,
then D(M) = M∗ and D(M∗) = M .
Chapter 2
String algebras
In this chapter we will outline some relevant background material about
finite-dimensional string algebras. We begin by defining combinatorial objects known
as strings and bands consisting of words made up of letters arising from arrows in
the quiver. These combinatorial objects allow us to construct some indecomposable
modules whose structure reflects that of the corresponding string or band. In Section
2.3 we will describe the construction of these modules.
The finite-dimensional modules over a string algebra are known to be exactly the
finite-dimensional string and band modules (the proof of this can be found in [20]
or [16]; Butler and Ringel credit their method to [23]). The classification of the
indecomposable representations has led to many other results to do with the category
of finitely presented modules. In Section 2.4 we give a survey of some of these results.
In a recent paper [48], Prest and Puninski proved that if we include infinite strings,
then the strings and bands also parametrise the points of the Ziegler spectrum of a
domestic string algebra. We describe their result in Section 2.5, as well as some related
results regarding the Cantor-Bendixson rank and the Krull-Gabriel dimension of the
functor category.
2.1 Definition of a string algebra
Let Q = (Q0, Q1) be a finite quiver and I an admissible ideal of the path algebra
kQ over a field k. The algebra A = kQ/I is a monomial algebra if the ideal I is
generated by paths of length at least two. For each arrow a ∈ Q1, let s(a) ∈ Q0 denote
43
44 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
the starting point of a and let e(a) ∈ Q0 denote the ending point of a.
Definition 2.1.1. A monomial algebra A = kQ/I is a string algebra if the following
conditions hold:
1. For all x ∈ Q0, there are at most two arrows a, b ∈ Q1 such that s(a) = s(b) = x.
2. For all x ∈ Q0, there are at most two arrows c, d ∈ Q1 such that e(c) = e(d) = x.
3. For all b ∈ Q1, there is at most one arrow a ∈ Q1 such that ab /∈ I.
4. For all b ∈ Q1, there is at most one arrow c ∈ Q1 such that bc /∈ I.
If the ideal I is generated by paths of length 2 and we replace the last two conditions
with the following conditions.
3’. For all b ∈ Q1, there is at most one arrow a ∈ Q1 such that ab /∈ I and at most
one a′ ∈ Q1 such that s(a′) = e(b) and a′b ∈ I.
4’. For all b ∈ Q1, there is at most one arrow c ∈ Q1 such that bc /∈ I and at most
one c′ ∈ Q1 such that s(b) = e(c′) and bc′ ∈ I.
then A is said to be a gentle algebra.
For each string algebra, it will be useful to fix functions σ, ε : Q1 → {1,−1} with
the following properties:
1. If a 6= b are arrows with s(a) = s(b) then σ(a) = −σ(b).
2. If c 6= d are arrows with e(c) = e(d) then ε(c) = −ε(d).
3. If a and b are arrows with s(a) = e(b) and ab /∈ I then σ(a) = −ε(b).
2.2 Strings and bands
Throughout this section A = kQ/I will be a monomial algebra. For each a ∈ Q1 we
introduce a formal inverse a− and extend the functions s and t so that s(a−) = e(a)
and e(a−) = s(a). Let Q−1 := {a− | a ∈ Q1}. We will refer to the elements of the set
Q1 tQ−1 as letters. A letter u contained in Q1 will be referred to as a direct letter
and a letter u contained in Q−1 will be referred to as an inverse letter. Also if u = a−
where a is a direct letter then u− = a.
2.2. STRINGS AND BANDS 45
2.2.1 Finite strings
Definition 2.2.1. A sequence of letters u = un . . . u1 is a string (of length n) if the
following conditions hold:
1. For all 1 ≤ i < n, we have that e(ui) = s(ui+1).
2. For all 1 ≤ i < n, we have that ui 6= u−i+1.
3. For all 1 ≤ i < i+ k ≤ n, neither the sequence ui+k . . . ui nor the sequence
u−i . . . u−i+k is contained in I.
For such a string u = un . . . u1, we extend the definitions of inverse, starting and
ending in the obvious ways: u− = u−1 . . . u−n , s(u) = s(u1) and e(u) = e(un). We will
refer to u1 as the first letter of u and to un as the last letter of u.
For each vertex x ∈ Q0 we introduce two strings 1(x,1), 1(x,−1) of length zero. For
i ∈ {1,−1} we have that 1−(x,i) = 1(x,−i) and s(1(x,i)) = e(1(x,i)) = x. (In the second half
of the thesis we will only consider one string of length zero for every vertex x ∈ Q0; it
is purely for technical reasons that we require two such strings here). If u = un . . . u1
and v = vm . . . v1 are strings then the concatenation of u and v is defined to be
uv = un . . . u1vm . . . v1 provided the sequence un . . . u1vm . . . v1 satisfies the conditions
in Definition 2.2.1. Otherwise the concatenation of u and v is not defined.
If every letter of a string u is direct then we say that u is a direct string. If every
letter of u is inverse then we say that u is an inverse string. The strings of length
zero are considered to be both direct and inverse.
If A is a string algebra, we extend the functions σ, ε to the set of strings in the
obvious way: For an inverse letter l ∈ Q−1 , let σ(l) = ε(l−) and ε(l) = σ(l−); For a
string u = ln . . . l1 of length n > 0, let σ(u) = σ(l1) and ε(u) = ε(ln); For x ∈ Q0, let
σ(1(x,i)) = −i and ε(1(x,i)) = i.
If uv is defined then σ(u) = −ε(v) but, unless A is a gentle algebra, the converse is
not true since uv must also satisfy the third condition of Definition 2.2.1. We say that
the concatenation 1(x,i)u is defined and equal to u if e(u) = x and ε(u) = i. Similarly,
the concatenation u1(x,i) is defined and equal to u if s(u) = x and σ(u) = −i.
46 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
2.2.2 Bands
A string b of length n ≥ 1 is cyclic if s(b) = e(b). If, in addition, there is no string u
such that the m-fold concatenation u . . . u is equal to b then b is a primitive cyclic
string. If a primitive cyclic string b = bn . . . b1 is such that bm 6= 0 for all m ≥ 1 and
also b1 is an inverse letter and bn is a direct letter, then b is a band.
2.2.3 Infinite strings
Consider a sequence of letters u = . . . u2u1 indexed by N and unbounded to the left.
Then u is a (left) N-string if un . . . u1 is a string for every n ∈ N. If u is a left N-string,
then s(u) = s(u1) and σ(u) = σ(u1). A sequence v = v−1v−2 . . . is a (right) N-string
if v−1 . . . v−n is a string for every n ∈ N. Also e(v) = e(v−1) and ε(v) = ε(v−1). A
Z-indexed sequence of letters v = . . . v2v1v0v−1 . . . is a Z-string if vi . . . vj is a string
for every pair of integers i ≥ j. We will refer to N- and Z-strings as infinite strings.
We extend the definition of v− to infinite strings in the obvious way.
Let u be a left N-string. The string u is periodic if there exists some primitive
cyclic string c such that u = . . . cc. We will use the notation u = ∞c. A left N-string u
is almost periodic if it is periodic or if there is some primitive cyclic string c and some
finite string v = v0 · · · v−m such that u = ∞cv and ∞cv0 is not periodic. We say that
∞c is the maximal periodic substring of u. We say that an almost periodic string
u = ∞cv is expanding if the last letter of c is direct. We say that u is contracting
if the last letter of c is inverse. The definitions periodic, almost periodic, expanding
and contracting apply to a right N-string u if they apply to the left N-string u−.
A Z-string v is periodic if there is some primitive cyclic string c with v = ∞c∞.
A Z-string v is almost periodic if it is not periodic but there exist almost periodic
N-strings u and w such that v = wu. Suppose w = . . . v2v1 and u = v0v−1v−2 . . . , then
w is a left maximal periodic substring if it is periodic and wv0 is not periodic. If
v = wu has such a left maximal periodic substring w = ∞c, then v is left expanding
if the last letter of c is direct and v is left contracting if the last letter of c is inverse.
An almost periodic Z-string v is
• expanding if both v and v− are left expanding;
• contracting if both v and v− are left contracting; and
2.2. STRINGS AND BANDS 47
• mixed if one of v and v− is left expanding and the other is left contracting.
Example 2.2.2. Consider the algebra given by the quiver
• beea 99
with relations ab = b2 = a2 = 0. Then
• the string ∞(ba−)b− is an expanding left N-string with maximal cyclic substring
∞(ba−);
• the string ba−(ab−)∞ is a contracting right N-string; and
• the string v = ∞(ba−)(ab−)∞ is the unique almost periodic Z-string. The string
∞(ba−) is its left maximal periodic substring and so v is left expanding. The
string v− is left contracting since ∞(a−b) is its maximal periodic substring, there-
fore v is a mixed Z-string.
2.2.4 Equivalence relations
Finite strings We say that strings u∼−1v for strings u, v if and only if u = v− or
u = v . Let St denote a fixed set of representatives of ∼−1-equivalence classes of
finite strings.
Bands We say that b∼rc for bands b, c if and only if we have b = bn . . . b1 and we
have c = bi . . . b1bn . . . bi+1 for some 1 ≤ i < n. Let Ba denote a fixed set of
representatives of ∼r-equivalence classes of bands.
We say that b∼bc if and only if b∼−1c or b∼rc. Then let Ban denote the set of
∼b-equivalence classes.
Infinite strings Let Con be a fixed set of representatives of ∼−1-equivalence classes
of contracting N- and Z-strings.
Let Exp be a fixed set of representatives of ∼−1-equivalence classes of expanding
N- and Z-strings.
Let Mix be a fixed set of representatives of ∼−1-equivalence classes of mixed
Z-strings. We take the representative of each equivalence classes to be the left
expanding one.
48 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
2.3 Some indecomposable modules
Let A = kQ/I be a monomial algebra. In this section we describe the construction of
string and band modules over A. The infinite-dimensional string modules were first
described in [50].
2.3.1 Finite-dimensional string modules
Let u = un . . . u1 be a string of length n ≥ 1. Define a function
t : {0, 1, . . . , n} → Q0 where t(i) :=
s(u1) if i = 0,
e(ui) if i 6= 0.
Then for each x ∈ Q0, let Ix := {i | t(i) = x}. From this data we define the string
module M(u) over A as follows:
• For each x ∈ Q0 take the vector space Mx =⊕
i∈Ix Ki where Ki∼= k for each
i ∈ Ix.
• For each a ∈ Q1 with s(a) = x and e(a) = y take the matrix
Ma :⊕i∈Ix
Ki →⊕j∈Iy
Kj
with entries
(Ma)i,j :=
idk if j = i+ 1 and uj = a,
idk if i = j + 1 and ui = a−,
0 otherwise.
It will be useful to fix a basis for the vector spaces Mx so let zi denote the basis
element spanning Ki for 0 ≤ i ≤ n. We refer to this as a canonical basis element
of M(u). We may also refer to zi as the basis element between ui and ui+1 when
0 < i < n.
Example 2.3.1. Consider the algebra
• beea 99
2.3. SOME INDECOMPOSABLE MODULES 49
with relations ab = b2 = a2 = 0. Consider the finite string u = ba−b−ab−. We depict
the string module M(u) as follows.
k
1k
b
�� 1k
a
��k k
1k
b
��
k
1k
a
�� 1k
b
��k k
2.3.2 Finite-dimensional band modules
Let b = bn . . . b1 be a band and let M = (U,Φ) be a finite-dimensional k[T, T−1]-
module. That is U is a finite-dimensional vector space and Φ is an invertible linear
endomorphism Φ: U → U corresponding to multiplication by T . For each vertex
x ∈ Q0, let Jx := {j | t(bj) = x}.
We define the band module B(b,M) as follows:
• For each x ∈ Q0 take the vector space Bx :=⊕
j∈Jx Uj where Uj ∼= U for each
j ∈ Jx.
• For each a ∈ Q1 with s(a) = x and e(a) = y take the matrix
Ba :⊕i∈Jx
Ui →⊕j∈Jy
Uj
with entries
(Ba)i,j :=
idU if j = i+ 1 and bj = a,
idU if i = j + 1, i 6= 1 and bi = a−,
Φ if i = 1, j = 2 and b1 = a−,
0 otherwise.
Recall from Example 1.2.1 that when k is algebraically closed the finite-dimensional
k[T, T−1]-modules are of the form Mk,n = (kn, Jk,n) for some k ∈ k∗. We follow Schroer
in [55] and fix a canonical basis {z(j)i | 1 ≤ i ≤ m, 1 ≤ j ≤ n} for the band module
B(b,Mk,n) with band b = bm . . . b1. The action of a ∈ Q1 on the canonical basis is as
50 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
follows
a.z(j)1 =
kz(1)m if j = 1, a = bm
kz(j)m + z
(j−1)m if j 6= 1, a = bm
z(j)2 if a = b−1
0 otherwise.
and for i 6= 1
a.z(j)i =
z
(j)i−1 if a = b−i−1
z(j)i+1 if a = bi
0 otherwise.
Example 2.3.2. Consider the Kronecker algebra • •b
hhavv
. There is a unique band
b = ab− (up to equivalence). Let M = (U,Φ) be a finite-dimensional k[T, T−1]-module.
Then we will depict the band module B(b,M) as follows.
U Ub=Φ
ii
a=1Uuu
Now suppose that k is algebraically closed. The above picture can be expanded;
we will depict B(b,M3,k) for some k ∈ k∗.
k k k k1kqq
kmm k1kii
k
hh
1k
vvk
k
ee
1k
yy
1k
gg
2.3.3 Infinite-dimensional string modules
Let u be a left N-string (in which case u = . . . u2u1) or a Z-string (in which case
u = . . . u2u1u0u−1 . . . ). Extend the function given in Section 2.3.1 in the following
way:
If u is a left N-string then let
t : {0, 1, 2 . . . } → Q0 where t(i) :=
s(u1) if i = 0,
e(ui) if i 6= 0.
2.3. SOME INDECOMPOSABLE MODULES 51
and if u is a Z-string then let t : Z→ Q0 where t(i) := e(ui).
Then again for each x ∈ Q0, let Ix := {i | t(i) = x}. From this data we define the
direct-sum module M(u) over A as follows:
• For each x ∈ Q0 take the vector space Mx =⊕
i∈Ix Ki where Ki∼= k for each
i ∈ Ix.
• For each a ∈ Q1 with s(a) = x and e(a) = y take the (infinite) matrix
Ma :⊕i∈Ix
Ki →⊕j∈Iy
Kj
with entries
(Ma)i,j :=
idk if j = i+ 1 and uj = a,
idk if i = j + 1 and ui = a−,
0 otherwise.
Similarly, we define the direct-product module N(u) over A as follows:
• For each x ∈ Q0 take the vector space Nx =∏
i∈Ix Ki where Ki∼= k for each
i ∈ Ix.
• For each a ∈ Q1 with s(a) = x and e(a) = y take the (infinite) matrix
Na :∏i∈Ix
Ki →∏j∈Iy
Kj
with entries
(Na)i,j :=
idk if j = i+ 1 and uj = a,
idk if i = j + 1 and ui = a−,
0 otherwise.
If u is a right N-string, then define M(u) := M(u−) and N(u) := N(u−). We can,
of course, adjust the above constructions to directly construct a direct sum module
and a direct product module associated to u; the modules M(u) and N(u), as we
have defined it, is isomorphic to the direct sum module and the direct product module
constructed in this way.
Whenever u is a Z-string we define the (left) mixed module L(u) over A to be
the submodule of N(u) given as follows:
52 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
• For each x ∈ Q0 take the subspace Lx of Nx containing elements (ki)i∈Ix such
that ki = 0 for i� 0 .
• For each a ∈ Q1 with s(a) = x and e(a) = y take the (infinite) matrix
La : Lx → Ly
with entries
(La)i,j :=
idk if j = i+ 1 and uj = a,
idk if i = j + 1 and ui = a−,
0 otherwise.
We define the (right) mixed module R(u) to be L(u−).
As in the finite-dimensional case, we will let zi denote a fixed basis element spanning
each vector space Ki.
Theorem 2.3.3 ([50]). Let A be a monomial algebra and let u be an almost periodic
infinite string. Then the following modules are pure injective:
1. M(u) when u is a contracting N- or Z-string.
2. N(u) when u is an expanding N- or Z-string.
3. L(u) when u is a mixed Z-string such that u left expanding.
4. R(u) when u is a mixed Z-string such that u is left contracting.
For each almost periodic infinite string u over a monomial algebra, we will denote
the corresponding indecomposable pure-injective by C(u).
2.3.4 Infinite-dimensional band modules
Let b = bn . . . b1 be a band and let M = (U,Φ) be a infinite-dimensional indecompos-
able pure-injective k[T, T−1]-module (see Example 1.2.1). That is, U is the underlying
vector space of a Prufer, adic or generic module and Φ is the automorphism of U given
by u→ T.u. We define the band module B(b,M) as in Section 2.3.2.
The construction described in Section 2.3.2 can be used to define a functor
Fb : k[T, T−1]-Mod → A-Mod and in this section we will give a short argument es-
tablishing that this functor is a representation embedding.
2.3. SOME INDECOMPOSABLE MODULES 53
Recall, from Section 1.4, that if R and S are finite-dimensional k-algebras, then a
functor F : R-Mod → S-Mod is a representation embedding if it is a k-linear, exact
functor that reflects isomorphism and preserves direct sums, direct products and inde-
composability. An equivalent characterisation is that F preserves indecomposability,
reflects isomorphisms and F ∼= M ⊗R − for M an (S,R)-bimodule that is finitely
generated as a right R-module and such that k acts centrally on M .
Proposition 2.3.4. Let b be a band over a monomial algebra A. Then the functor
Fb : k[T, T−1]-Mod→ A-Mod given by M 7→ B(b,M) is a representation embedding.
Proof. Suppose b = bn . . . b1. It is clear from the construction that Fb both preserves
indecomposability and reflects isomorphism. It remains to show that Fb is isomorphic
to an appropriate tensor product functor.
Let v = ∞b∞ and label the letters of v = . . . v2v1v0v−1 . . . so that vi+jn = bi for all
1 ≤ i ≤ n and j ∈ Z. Consider the direct sum module M(v). We follow the notation
from Sections 2.3.2 and 2.3.3. M(v) is an (A,k[T, T−1])-bimodule with T acting on
basis elements of M(v) as T.zt = zt+n; this is the shift endomorphism described in
[50]. It is clear from this that M(v) is finitely-generated as a k[T, T−1]-module and k
acts centrally on M(v).
Next we show that Fb is isomorphic to the functor M(v)⊗k[T,T−1] −. Given that
M(v) ∼= M(v)⊗k[T,T−1] k[T, T−1] we can explicitly describe an isomorphism between
Fb(k[T, T−1]) and M(v)⊗k[T,T−1] k[T, T−1] as follows:
Ψ: Fb(k[T, T−1])→M(v)
where for each u = k−tT−t + · · · + k0 + k1T + · · · + kmT
m ∈ Ui ∼= k[T, T−1] we have
that Ψ(u) =∑m
j=−t kjzi+jn. Since Fb and M(v)⊗k[T,T−1] − are both right exact and
commute with finite direct sums, it follows that Fb(M) ∼= M(v)⊗k[T,T−1] M for any
finitely presented module M . Moreover, both functors commute with direct limits so
the isomorphism holds for arbitrary M .
Theorem 2.3.5 ([42, Thm. 7]). Suppose that R and S are rings and
Φ: S-Mod→ R-Mod
is a representation embedding. Then Φ induces a homeomorphism between SZg and a
closed subset of RZg.
54 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
It follows that the set of isomorphism classes of (finite- and infinite-dimensional)
band modules is a closed subset of AZg.
2.4 The module category of a string algebra
The fact that all the indecomposable modules in A-mod can be described so explicitly
means that many questions that are hard to answer in general become tractable when
restricted to the class of string algebras. In particular, we have a description of the
Auslander-Reiten structure of A-mod [16] and, more surprisingly, we also have an ex-
plicit description of a nice basis for HomA(M,N) when M and N are any indecompos-
able modules. This description can be found in a series of papers by Crawley-Boevey
and Krause [18, 19, 29].
In this section we will first give an account of the construction of the Auslander-
Reiten sequences in A-mod. Next we will define the basic morphisms between finite-
dimensional string and band modules and use this to describe the hammock posets
introduced by Schroer [52]. We will prove that the morphisms between indecomposable
finite-dimensional modules and the indecomposable infinite-dimensional pure-injective
modules are determined by where the associated infinite string or band fits into the
hammock poset. This observation is a central component of the argument given in the
next section to determine the Cantor-Bendixson rank of Ziegler spectrum.
2.4.1 Auslander-Reiten sequences for string algebras
Let A = kQ/I be a string algebra. In this section we present results from [16] in which
Butler and Ringel describe the Auslander-Reiten sequences for a string algebra. An
important property of string algebras is that the possible number of middle terms in
an Auslander-Reiten sequence is bounded above by two.
We begin by describing the Auslander-Reiten sequences with one middle term. For
each arrow a ∈ Q1, let la = b−l . . . b−1 be the inverse string of greatest length such that
laa is a string. Similarly, let ra = c−r . . . c−1 be the inverse string of greatest length such
that ara is a string. Finally, let ua = laara.
Since la is an image substring of ua and ra is a factor substring of ua, there are
induced graph maps f : M(la)→M(ua) and g : M(ua)→M(ra).
2.4. THE MODULE CATEGORY OF A STRING ALGEBRA 55
Proposition 2.4.1. For each a ∈ Q1, the sequence
0→M(la)f→M(ua)
g→M(ra)→ 0
is an Auslander-Reiten sequence.
If u is of the form la for some a ∈ Q1, we will also denote ua by u+ and f will be
denoted f+ : M(u)→M(u+).
Example 2.4.2. Consider the algebra Λ2 given by the quiver
1b
66a((2 c // 3
e66
d((4
with relations cb = ec = 0. Then for the arrow e, we have the Auslander-Reiten
sequence 0 → M(le)f→ M(ue)
g→ M(re) → 0 where M(le) is given by the following
diagram.
k1k
a��k
1kc��k
1k
d ��k
which embeds into M(ue) which is given by the following.
k1k
a��k
1kc��k
1k
d ��
k1k
e��
1k
d ��k k
which projects onto M(re) as in the following diagram.
k1k
d ��k
56 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
Next we describe the Auslander-Reiten sequences with two middle terms. Let u be
a string. Assume that M(u) is not injective and u is not of the form la for any a ∈ Q1.
The following algorithm produces an Auslander-Reiten sequence starting at M(u).
Consider the start of u: 1. Suppose there exists an arrow b ∈ Q1 such that ub is
a string. Then let u+ := ubv where v is the inverse string of greatest length
such that ubv is a string.
2. Suppose there is no arrow b ∈ Q1 such that ub is a string. Then let u+ := w
where u = wd−v where v is a direct string.
In the first case u is a substring of u+ and in the second case u+ is a factor substring
of u. Thus, denote the induced graph map by f+ : M(u)→M(u+).
Consider the end of u: 1. Suppose there exists an arrow b ∈ Q1 such that b−u is
a string. Then let +u := vb−u where v is the direct string of greatest length
such that vb−u is a string.
2. Suppose there is no arrow b ∈ Q1 such that b−u is a string. Then let
+u := w where u = vdw where v is an inverse string.
In the first case u is a substring of +u and in the second case +u is a factor substring
of u. Thus, denote the induced graph map by f+ : M(u)→M(+u).
Example 2.4.3. Consider the algebra Λ2 as in Example 2.4.2 and consider the string
u = c−d−e. Then M(u) is given by the following diagram.
k1k
c��k
1k
d ��
k1k
e��
k
If we apply the first algorithm to M(u) then we produce the following module M(u+).
k1k
c��k
2.4. THE MODULE CATEGORY OF A STRING ALGEBRA 57
When we apply the second algorithm we obtain the module M(+u) given by the
following diagram.
k1k
b��
1ka��
k k1k
c��k
1k
d ��
k1k
e��
k
The third term of the Auslander-Reiten sequence is therefore the module M(+u+)
given by the following diagram.
k1k
b��
1ka��
k k1k
c��k
Proposition 2.4.4. Let u be a string such that M(u) is not injective and u is not of
the form la for any a ∈ Q1. Then
0→M(u)
(f++f
)−→ M(u+)⊕M(+u)
( +g −g+ )−→ τ−1(M(u))→ 0
is an Auslander-Reiten sequence. Moreover, we have that τ−1(M(u)) = M(+u+) and
g+ : M(u+)→M(+u+) and +g : M(+u)→M(+u+) are the obvious graph maps.
Theorem 2.4.5 ([16]). Let A be a string algebra. The Auslander-Reiten sequences in
A-mod are those described in Propositions 2.4.1 and 2.4.4, together with those of the
form
0→ Fb(L)→ Fb(M)→ Fb(N)→ 0
where b is a band and 0 → L → M → N → 0 is an Auslander-Reiten sequence in
k[T, T−1]-mod.
58 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
2.4.2 Morphisms between string modules
In this and the next few sections we describe a basis for the morphisms between finite-
dimensional string and band modules over a monomial algebra A. The description
was originally given by Crawley-Boevey and Krause in a series of papers: [18], [19]
and [29].
Let u = un . . . u1 be a string and v = ui . . . uj a substring of u (so 1 ≤ j ≤ i ≤ n.
Then we say that v is an image substring (of u) if ui+1 is inverse or i = n and also
uj−1 is direct or j = 1. Similarly, if ui+1 is inverse and ui is direct for some 1 ≤ i ≤ n
then the string 1(e(ui),ε(ui)) is also an image substring of u.
Dually we say that v is a factor substring (of u) if ui+1 is direct or i = n and
also uj−1 is inverse or j = 1. If ui+1 is direct and ui is inverse for some 1 ≤ i ≤ n then
the string 1(e(ui),ε(ui)) is also a factor substring of u. If u is of length zero then u itself
is its unique factor substring and its unique image substring.
If v is an factor substring of u, then there is an epimorphism M(u)→M(v). Also,
if v is an image substring of w , then there is a monomorphism M(v) → M(w). A
composition f : M(u) → M(w) of two such morphisms is known as a graph map
(between string modules) and v will be referred to as the string associated to f .
Example 2.4.6. Consider the algebra given by the quiver • beea 99 with relations
ab = b2 = a2 = 0. Let u = ba−ba−b−a and let w = a−ba−b. Then the string
v = a−ba− is a factor substring of u and an image substring of w . Thus we have a
morphism M(u) → M(w) that factors as an epimorphism onto M(v) followed by a
monomorphism. These morphisms can be visualised as follows.
k1k
b��1k
a ��
1k
��
k
1k
��
1k
b��1k
a ��k k
1k
��
k
1k
��
1k
b ��
k1k
a��k
k
1k
��
1k
a ��
k
1k
��
1k
a ��
1k
b��k
1k
��
k
1k
��k 1k
a ��
k 1k
a ��
1k
b��
k1k
b��k k
2.4. THE MODULE CATEGORY OF A STRING ALGEBRA 59
Remark 2.4.7. The definition of a graph map f as it stands fixes the orientation of
the string v associated to f as a substring of u and w . Since M(v) ∼= M(v−) we will
include in the collection of graph maps M(u)→M(w) compositions of the form
M(u)→M(v)∼=−→M(v−)→M(w)
Proposition 2.4.8 ([18]). Let A be a monomial algebra and let u and v be finite
strings. If G is the collection of graph maps M(u)→M(w), then G is a k-linear basis
for HomA(M(u),M(w)).
2.4.3 Morphisms between string and band modules
Let b be a band and M = (U,Φ) a finite-dimensional k[T, T−1]-module. If v is a
finite factor substring of ∞b∞ and g ∈ Homk(U,k) then we can define a morphism
B(b,M)→ M(v). The composition f : B(b,M)→ M(w) of such a morphism with a
graph map M(v) → M(w) between string modules will be known as a graph map
(from a band module to a string module) and v will be known as the string
associated to f .
Example 2.4.9. Consider the Kronecker algebra given by the quiver •a ))
b
55 • . If
M = (U,Φ) is an indecomposable finite-dimensional k[T, T−1]-module and b = ba−,
then the corresponding band module B(b,M) is given by the following
UΦ = a))
1U = b55 U .
Fix g ∈ Homk(U,k) and consider the factor substring u = a−b of ∞b∞. The following
depicts a graph map f : B(b,M)→M(u).
UΦ=a ))
1U=b
55
g
##
gΦ−1 ��
U
gΦ−1
{{k b
1k &&k
k
a
1k
88
Similarly, if v is a finite image substring of ∞b∞ and g ∈ Homk(k, U) then we can
define a morphism M(v) → B(b,M). The composition f : M(w) → B(b,M) of such
a morphism with a graph map M(w)→M(v) will be known as a graph map (from
a string module to a band module) and v the associated string.
60 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
Example 2.4.10. Consider the Kronecker algebra (as in Example 2.4.9) and fix g ∈
Homk(k, U) and consider the image substring v = ba−ba− of ∞b∞. A graph map
f : M(v)→ B(b,Φ) is shown below.
k
Φ2g
zz
k
1k=a 88
1k=b
&&
Φg
��
k
Φg
��
k
1k=a 88
1k=b
&&
g
��
k
g
��U
Φ=a ))
1U=b
55 U
Remark 2.4.11. Let f : M(w) → B(b,M) be a graph map from a string module to
a band module with v the associated string. There are, in general, several possible
morphisms k → U that could be used to define f . For instance, in Example 2.4.10
we could use g, Φg or Φ2g. Thus, for each graph map f , we fix the representative of
the equivalence class of v and say that f is determined by the element of Homk(k, U)
corresponding to the (left) end of v . So in Example 2.4.10, we choose v = ba−ba− (as
opposed to v− = ab−ab−) and f is determined by g.
Proposition 2.4.12 ([29]). Let A be a monomial algebra. Suppose b is a band and
M = (U,Φ) a finite-dimensional k[T, T−1]-module.
1. Fix a basis BL for the finite-dimensional k-vector space Homk(U,k) and let GLbe the collection of graph maps B(b,M)→M(w) determined by the elements of
BL. Then GL is a k-linear basis for the vector space HomA(B(b,M),M(w)).
2. Fix a basis BR for the finite-dimensional k-vector space Homk(k, U) and let GRbe the collection of graph maps M(w)→ B(b,M) determined by the elements of
BR. Then GR is a k-linear basis for the vector space HomA(M(w), B(b,M)).
2.4.4 Morphisms between band modules
Let b and c be bands, and let M = (U,Φ) and N = (V,Ψ) be finite-dimensional
k[T, T−1]-modules. Consider a finite string u such that u is a factor substring of
∞b∞ and an image substring of ∞c∞. Then, for any g ∈ Homk(U, V ) there exists a
2.4. THE MODULE CATEGORY OF A STRING ALGEBRA 61
morphism f : B(b,M)→ B(c, N) defined in a similar way to the graph maps between
string and band modules. As before, we say that v is the string associated to f and,
fixing the representative of the equivalence class of v , we say that g ∈ Homk(U, V )
determines f if g is the morphism corresponding to the end of v ; see Remark 2.4.11.
Example 2.4.13. Consider the algebra given by the quiver
• beea 99
with relations ab = b3 = a3 = 0. Then there is a band b = ab− and a band c = aab−b−.
If we fix a k-linear morphism g ∈ Homk(U, V ), then we have the following graph map
B(b,M)→ B(c, N).
U4
f��
bgga 77
V 2bgga 77
where the actions of a and b on U4 are given by the following matrices.
a =
0 1U 0 0
0 0 0 1U
0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0
b =
0 0 0 Φ
0 0 0 0
0 0 0 0
0 0 1U 0
and the actions of a and b on V 2 are given by the following matrices.
a =
0 1V
0 0
b =
0 Ψ
0 0
and f is given by
f =
0 g 0 Φg
0 0 g 0
.
The structure of this morphism is clearer if we consider the infinite strings ∞b∞
and ∞c∞. In the following diagram, the copies of U and V are denoted Ui and Vj for
62 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
1 ≤ i ≤ 4 and 1 ≤ j ≤ 2 and we identify appropriate copies of U and V .
U3
g
��
a
1k}} b
1k!!
· · · U4
b
Φ!!
U2
g
��
a
1k}}
U4
Φg
��
b
Φ!!
U2
a
1k}}
· · ·
U1 U1
· · · V2
a
1k
}} b
Ψ
!!
V2
b
Ψ
!!a
1k
}}
V2
a
1k
}} b
Ψ
!!
· · ·
V1 V1 V1 V1
Such a morphism, together with any morphism of the form Fb(f) for some f in
Homk[T,T−1](M,N), will be referred to as a graph map (between band modules).
Proposition 2.4.14 ([18]). Let A be a monomial algebra, let b and c be bands, and
let M = (U,Φ) and N = (V,Ψ) be finite-dimensional k[T, T−1]-modules. Then
• Fix bases Bk and Bk[T,T−1] for the finite-dimensional k-vector spaces Homk(U, V )
and Homk[T,T−1](M,N) respectively.
• Define Gk to be the set of graph maps B(b,M)→ B(c, N) determined by elements
of Bk.
• Define Gk[T,T−1] to be the set of graph maps of the form Fb(g) for g ∈ Bk[T,T−1] if
b = c and the empty set otherwise.
Then the set G := Gk ∩ Gk[T,T−1] is a k-linear basis for HomA(B(b,M), B(c, N)).
2.4.5 Hammock posets and factorisations of graph maps
Let A = kQ/I be a string algebra over an algebraically closed field k. In this section
we give a brief description of the hammock posets for A introduced by Schroer in
his thesis [52]. The elements of the posets represent (pointed) indecomposable finite-
dimensional modules over A and pairs u < v in the poset represent (pointed) graph
maps between finite-dimensional modules. The elements of intervals [u, v ] in the posets
represent all the possible factorisations f = g2g1 of the graph map f corresponding to
x < y such that g1, g2 are graph maps. These posets are the main tool used by Schroer
to determine for which ordinals α we have radαA = 0.
2.4. THE MODULE CATEGORY OF A STRING ALGEBRA 63
Let x ∈ Q0. We partition the strings with an endpoint at x into two sets H1(x)
and H−1(x) using the ε and σ functions. We think of the strings in H−1(x) as those
extending to the right of x i.e. ending at x and we think of the strings in H1(x) as
those extending to the left of x i.e. starting at x.
H−1(x) := {v ∈ St | e(v) = x and ε(v) = 1}
We define a linear ordering on H−1(x): For u, v ∈ H−1(x) let u < v if one of the
following holds.
1. v = uax for a ∈ Q1 and x ∈ St.
2. u = vb−1y for b ∈ Q1 and y ∈ St.
3. v = zax and u = zb−1y for a, b ∈ Q1 and x , y , z ∈ St.
Let
H1(x) := {v ∈ St | s(v) = x and σ(v) = −1}
We define a linear ordering on H1(x): For u, v ∈ H1(x) let u < v if v−1 < u−1 in
H−1(x).
Example 2.4.15. Consider the Kronecker algebra given by the quiver 1a ))
b
55 2 and
suppose σ(b−) = −1 and ε(a) = 1 (this determines ε and σ). Then
H−1(2) = {1(2,1) < ab− < ab−ab− < · · · < ab−ab−a < ab−a < a}
and
H1(2) = {1(2,1) < ab− < ab−ab− < · · · < b−ab−ab− < b−ab− < b−}.
Note that, although some strings occur in both posets (with the exception of the trivial
strings) they are pointed at opposite ends.
The definition of ε and σ mean that we can compose strings from H−1(x) with
those from H1(x) unless the relations on A prohibit it. Let
H(x) := {(v ,w) ∈ H1(x)×H−1(x) | u = vw ∈ St}.
We extend the orderings on H−1(x) and H1(x) to an ordering on H(x): For (v ,w),
(y , z) ∈ H(x) let (v ,w) < (y , z) if v ≤ y and w ≤ z (but not both v = y and w = z).
64 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
We can think of each element (v ,w) ∈ H(x) as the string u = vw with a dis-
tinguished vertex between w and v . When the location of the distinguished vertex
is obvious or unimportant we will refer to the string u as an element of H(x). The
definition of the ordering means that, if u, v ∈ H(x), then there is a graph map
f : M(u) → M(v) taking the distinguished vertex in u to the distinguished vertex in
v if and only if u ≤ v (or u− ≤ v).
In the arguments given in later sections, we are sometimes given an arbitrary string
module M(u) and we consider the graph maps going to or from M(u) based on the
ordering of the strings. Since M(u) ∼= M(u−), we must consider where both u and
u− occur in H(x) for each x ∈ Q0. Thus, when we consider the elements of H(x) as
strings with distinguished vertices, we will consider a pointed version of u− ∈ H(x) to
be an occurrence of a pointed version of u in H(x).
Let f : M(u)→M(v) be a graph map between string modules such that im(f) has
the simple module S(x) corresponding to the vertex x ∈ Q0 as a composition factor. It
follows that we can find canonical basis elements zu, zv in M(u) and M(v) respectively
such that f(zu) = zv. Thus we may consider u and v as elements of H(x) with u ≤ v
(taking inverse strings if we need to). Moreover, the interval
[u, v ] := {w ∈ H(x) | u ≤ w ≤ v}
corresponds to the proper factorisations f = g2g1 of f such that g1 and g2 are graph
maps between string modules.
Remark 2.4.16. Schroer extends the posets H(x) to include the graph maps to and
from finite-dimensional band modules. We will not use this poset in our arguments
but the idea is to first include the set B(x) of periodic point strings (∞bb2, b1b∞) such
that b2b1 = b. For any finite string u = (v ,w) ∈ H(x) and finite-dimensional band
module B(b,M), there is a graph map M(u)→ B(b,M) if and only if u < (∞bb2, b1b∞)
for some b2b1 = b. Similarly, there is a graph map B(b,M) → M(u) if and only if
(∞bb2, b1b∞) < u.
For each band there is a whole family of tubes containing finite-dimensional mod-
ules and so Schroer extends the poset to reflect this. We do not do this here but refer
the reader to [52, 54].
2.4. THE MODULE CATEGORY OF A STRING ALGEBRA 65
2.4.6 Hammock posets and morphisms between pure-injective
modules
Let A = kQ/I be a string algebra over an algebraically closed field k. In this section
we will extend the hammock posets for A to include the infinite strings corresponding
to the indecomposable infinite-dimensional pure-injective string modules. We will see
that these extended posets will indicate the existence of non-zero morphisms to and
from these modules. We have also seen that the periodic Z-strings indicate when
there is a non-zero morphism to or from a finite-dimensional band module; we will
see that the position of the periodic Z-strings also indicates the existence of non-zero
morphisms to and from the infinite-dimensional band modules.
Let Hi(x) be the poset obtained by including N-strings in the poset Hi(x) for
i ∈ {−1, 1} with the same ordering as before. Again, we can consider the poset
H(x) := {(v ,w) ∈ H1(x)× H−1(x) | u = vw ∈ St ∪ Exp ∪ Con ∪Mix}.
. For (v ,w), (y , z) ∈ H(x), let (v ,w) < (y , z) if and only if one of the following holds.
• v < x in H1(x) and w < z in H−1(x).
• v is a finite string, v = x and w < y in H−1(x).
• w is a finite string, v < x in H1(x) and w = y .
Remark 2.4.17. To define the ordering on H(x) we have added an extra condition
that rules out graph maps that are supported on infinitely many vertices of the string.
We do this because in Proposition 2.4.18 we will be considering graph maps between an
infinite-dimensional indecomposable module and a finite-dimensional indecomposable
module. The ‘graph maps’ that are supported on infinitely many degrees would give
rise to infinite sums of elements in the codomain and so are not well-defined. For the
duration of this remark we will refer to such a morphism as an infinite graph map.
Note that the only way an infinite graph map could arise is if it were between
a finite-dimensional band module B(b,M) and an infinite-dimensional string module
C(u) where (one of) the maximal periodic substrings of u is equivalent to b∞. Since
we want the ordering to reflect the morphisms between two such modules, we con-
sider the possible combinations and check that we have not excluded any well-defined
morphisms.
66 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
First consider infinite graph maps B(b,M) → C(u). Suppose C(u) is a direct
sum module (or a mixed module such that the contracting maximal periodic substring
of u is equivalent to b∞). Then the infinite graph map would not be a well-defined
morphism. Next suppose C(u) is a direct product module (or a mixed module such
that the expanding maximal periodic substring of u is equivalent to b∞). Then, since
the maximal periodic substring is expanding, there can be no infinite graph map
B(b,M)→ C(u).
Similarly, consider such an infinite graph map C(u) → B(b,M). If C(u) is a
direct product module (or a mixed module such that the expanding maximal periodic
substring of u is equivalent to b∞), then this infinite graph map is not well-defined.
But, again, if C(u) is a direct sum module (or a mixed module such that the contracting
maximal periodic substring of u is equivalent to b∞), then there can be no such graph
map since u is contracting string.
Proposition 2.4.18. Let w be an almost periodic string, u a finite string and let C(w)
and M(u) be the associated (indecomposable, pure-injective) string modules.
1. There exists a non-zero morphism M(u)→ C(w) if and only if u < w or u < w−
in H(x) for some x ∈ Q0.
2. There exists a non-zero morphism C(w)→M(u) if and only if w < u or w < u−
in H(x) for some x ∈ Q0.
3. Let c ∈ Ba and let l ∈ k∗, j ∈ N. Then there exists a non-zero morphism
B(c,Ml,j)→ C(w) if and only if (∞cc2, c1c∞) < w or (∞cc2, c1c∞) < w− in H(x)
for some x ∈ Q0 and c = c2c1.
4. Let c ∈ Ba and let l ∈ k∗, j ∈ N. Then there exists a non-zero morphism
C(w)→ B(c,Ml,j) if and only if w < (∞cc2, c1c∞) or w− < (∞cc2, c1c∞) in H(x)
for some x ∈ Q0 and c = c2c1.
Let M be an indecomposable infinite-dimensional pure-injective k[T, T−1]-module. That
is M = Mi,k for i ∈ {∞,−∞}, k ∈ k∗ or M = G (see Example 1.2.1). Let b ∈ Ba.
5. Let u be a finite string. Then there exists a non-zero morphism M(u)→ B(b,M)
if and only if u < (∞bb2, b1b∞) in H(x) for some x ∈ Q0 and b2b1 = b.
2.5. THE ZIEGLER SPECTRUM OF A DOMESTIC STRING ALGEBRA 67
6. Let u be a finite string. Then there exists a non-zero morphism B(b,M)→M(u)
if and only if (∞bb2, b1b∞) < u in H(x) for some x ∈ Q0 and b2b1 = b.
7. Let c ∈ Ba and let l ∈ k∗, j ∈ N. Then there exists a non-zero morphism
B(c,Ml,j)→ B(b,M) if and only if one of the following two conditions hold.
(a) We have (∞cc2, c1c∞) < (∞bb2, b1b∞) for some c2c1 = c and b2b1 = b.
(b) We have c = b and M = Ml,∞.
8. Let c ∈ Ba and let l ∈ k∗, j ∈ N. Then there exists a non-zero morphism
B(b,M)→ B(c,Ml,j) if and only if one of the following two conditions hold.
(a) We have (∞bb2, b1b∞) < (∞cc2, c1c∞) for some c2c1 = c and b2b1 = b.
(b) We have c = b and M = Ml,−∞.
Proof. In each case, it is immediate that, if the strings are ordered as stated, then there
will be a morphism as stated since we may construct a graph map as we described in
Sections 2.4.2, 2.4.3 and 2.4.4.
For the converse, we may use the same arguments as in [29] (or for string modules
[19, Lem. 1.4]) to obtain that if there is a morphism as stated in each case, then there
is an underlying common substring of the associated strings in H(x) for some x ∈ Q0
such that the end-points satisfy the conditions implied by the ordering on strings. In
Remark 2.4.17 we have already seen that this underlying common substring cannot be
infinite.
2.5 The Ziegler spectrum of a domestic string al-
gebra
As before, we will let A = kQ/I be a string algebra over an algebraically closed field
k. We say that A is domestic if there are only finitely many bands over A. Since it
follows from [16] that the one-parameter families of tubes in A-mod are indexed by
the bands, this notion of domestic is the same as the more general definition given in
Section 1.4.
68 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
Proposition 2.5.1 ([50, Prop. 2]). Let A be a string algebra. The following conditions
are equivalent:
1. A is domestic.
2. For each arrow a ∈ Q1, there is at most one band b = bn . . . b1 such that bn = a.
3. Any infinite string is almost periodic or periodic.
Following this result, Ringel conjectures that the indecomposable pure-injective
modules described in the preceding sections form a complete list of indecomposable
pure-injective modules over a domestic string algebra. More recently, Prest and Punin-
ski have confirmed this conjecture to obtain the following theorem.
Theorem 2.5.2 ([48, Thm. 5.1]). Let A be a domestic string algebra over an alge-
braically closed field k. Then the following is a complete list of the points of the Ziegler
spectrum AZg of A-Mod.
1. M(u) for all u ∈ St.
2. M(b,Φ) for all b ∈ Ba and each point (U,Φ) of the Ziegler spectrum k[T,T−1]Zg
of k[T, T−1]-Mod.
3. M(v) for all v ∈ Con.
4. N(v) for all v ∈ Exp.
5. L(v) for all v ∈ Mix.
In the same paper Prest and Puninski prove that there is no superdecomposable
pure-injective module over a domestic string algebra.
Theorem 2.5.3 ([48, Thm. 5.6]). Let A be a domestic string algebra over an alge-
braically closed field. Every pure-injective module over A contains an indecomposable
direct summand.
Remark 2.5.4. It follows from Proposition 1.3.10 that the isolation condition holds for
a domestic string algebra A. Thus, by Proposition 1.3.8, the Krull-Gabriel dimension
of (A-mod,Ab)fp
is equal to the Cantor-Bendixson rank of AZg.
2.5. THE ZIEGLER SPECTRUM OF A DOMESTIC STRING ALGEBRA 69
2.5.1 The transfinite radical and a lower bound for the Krull-
Gabriel dimension of a string algebra
We saw in Section 1.3.6 that there is some connection between the Krull-Gabriel
dimension of (R-mod,Ab)fp
where R is an Artin algebra and the transfinite powers
of the Jacobson radical radR of R-mod. In [54, 55] Schroer establishes the powers of
radA that are zero for a string algebra A and thus provides a lower bound for the
Krull-Gabriel dimension of (A-mod,Ab)fp
. The first result distinguishes between the
powers of the radical of domestic and non-domestic string algebras.
Theorem 2.5.5 ([54, Thm. 2]). Let A be a string algebra. The following are equivalent.
1. A is non-domestic.
2. The radical of A-mod is such that rad∞A 6= 0.
Let A be a domestic string algebra. In [54] (see also [52]) Schroer proves that the
ordinals α for which radαA = 0 are determined by the bridge quiver QBa defined below.
The idea of the bridge quiver of a domestic string algebra is that it describes the form
of the possible strings in terms of where copies of the bands may occur in a string.
Example 2.5.6. This example illustrates the idea of the bridge quiver. Consider the
quiver
•
w
��•uoo
v
��
with relations w2 = v2 = wuv = 0. Let the set Ba (defined in Section 2.2.4) consist of
the following bands:
b = uvu−1w−1
b−1 = wuv−1u−1.
All of the strings over the corresponding string algebra are substrings of a string of
the form b∞uvu−1b−∞ or b∞uv−1u−1b−∞. We then define the bridge quiver to have
vertices given by the bands and arrows given by the possible strings connecting them.
So in this example, the bridge quiver is the following.
buvu−1
++
uv−1u−1
33 b−1
70 CHAPTER 2. STRING ALGEBRAS
Let A be a domestic string algebra and let b, c ∈ Ba. We say that a finite string u
is a bridge from b to c if the following conditions are satisfied.
1. The concatenation buc is a string.
2. There is no primitive cyclic word d such that u = v2v1 (where v1 and v2 are
strings of positive length) and v2dv1 is a well-defined string.
We consider the quiver QBa = (QBa0 , QBa
1 ) of A where the vertex set QBa0 is given by
a fixed set of representatives of Ba. For b, c ∈ QBa0 , there is an arrow b → c in QBa
1
whenever there is a bridge u from b to c. This quiver is known as the bridge quiver
of A.
Theorem 2.5.7 ([54, Thms 3.10, 4.3]). Let A be a domestic string algebra. Let n be
the length of a maximal path in QBa, then
radω(n+1)A 6= 0 and rad
ω(n+2)A = 0.
Combined with Corollary 1.3.19, this gives us a lower bound for the Krull-Gabriel
dimension and hence the Cantor-Bendixson ranks of A.
Corollary 2.5.8. Let A be a domestic string algebra and let n be the length of a
maximal path in QBa, then the Krull-Gabriel dimension of A is equal to the Cantor-
Bendixson rank of A and is at least n+ 1.
Chapter 3
The Cantor-Bendixson rank and
Krull-Gabriel dimension of a
domestic string algebra
Throughout this chapter A = kQ/I will denote a domestic string algebra over an
algebraically closed field k and Zg will denote the Ziegler spectrum ZgA of A-mod. We
follow Prest and Puninski [48] in assuming that field is algebraically closed because
our results depend on their classification of the points of Zg, however it is not clear
that this is assumption is required for their classsifcation. the We have already seen
(Remark 2.5.4) that the Cantor-Bendixson rank of Zg is equal to the Krull-Gabriel
dimension of (A-mod,Ab)fp
and also that the simple functors at each stage of the Krull-
Gabriel analysis are in a one-to-one correspondence with the isolated modules at each
stage of the Cantor-Bendixson analysis. Moreover, we have a complete list of the
indecomposable pure-injective modules in A-Mod (see Theorem 2.5.2). We therefore
take the following strategy: we consider each module M ∈ Zg in turn and identify a
family of morphisms such that each F in the corresponding family of finitely presented
functors isolates that module at some stage in the Cantor-Bendixson analysis. We may
then conclude that the functor F is simple at the corresponding stage in the Krull-
Gabriel analysis and we may also deduce the Cantor-Bendixson rank M .
The results in this chapter are contained in paper in [36] which is joint work with
G. Puninski and M. Prest. The methods used here are exactly the same in the paper
but the language in which they are expressed is different. To translate between the
71
72 CHAPTER 3. CB-RANK AND KG-DIMENSION
two the reader should refer to [44, Sec. 3.1].
3.1 The Cantor-Bendixson rank of points
It is well-known that, over a finite-dimensional algebra, the simple functors in
(A-mod,Ab)fp
correspond to the functors F = (M,−)/ im(−, f) where M is an in-
decomposable finite-dimensional module and f : M → N is the left-hand side of an
almost split sequence (see [5, Sec. 2]). Thus the points in Zg with Cantor-Bendixson
rank 0 are exactly the indecomposable finite-dimensional modules.
Proposition 3.1.1. The points of the Ziegler spectrum Zg with Cantor-Bendixson
rank 0 are exactly the finite-dimensional string and band modules.
3.1.1 The Cantor-Bendixson rank of N-string modules
Let y be an N-string. We will identify certain serial functors F such that
(F ) ∩ Zg(α) = {C(y)}
for some ordinal α. A functor F in (A-mod,Ab)fp
is serial if its lattice L(F ) of finitely
presented subfunctors is a linearly ordered. The functors we describe here correspond
to the intervals of the pp lattice described in [46, Lem. 5.3]
Let u be a finite string such that M(u) is not injective and such that u 6= la for any
a ∈ Q1 (see Section 2.4.1 for the definition of la). Let x = s(u).
1. If σ(u) = −1 then suppose u < w in H1(x) and define
fu,w =[f1f2
]: M(u)→M(u+)⊕M(w)
where
• f1 : M(u) → M(u+) is the irreducible morphism described in Section 2.4.1
and
• f2 : M(u) → M(w) is the graph map induced by the ordering on H1(x)
described in Section 2.4.5.
3.1. THE CANTOR-BENDIXSON RANK OF POINTS 73
2. If σ(u) = 1 then ε(u−) = 1 so suppose u− < w in H−1(x) and let
fu,w =[f1f2
]: M(u)→M(+u)⊕M(w)
where
• f1 : M(u) → M(+u) is the irreducible morphism described in Section 2.4.1
and
• f2 : M(u) → M(w) is the graph map induced by the ordering on H−1(x)
described in Section 2.4.5.
Example 3.1.2. Consider the algebra given by the quiver
x beea 99
with relations ab = b2 = a2 = 0. The string u = ba−b−ab−a is not injective or of the
form ld for any d ∈ Q1. We choose w = a−ba−b−ab−a since u < w in H1(x). The
morphism fu,w is then given by the morphism f1 that may be depicted as follows.
k
1k
��
1k
b��1k
a ��k
1k
��
k
1k
��
1k
b ��
k
1k
��
1k
a��
1k
b ��
k1k
a��k
1k
��
k
k 1k
a ��
1k
b��k k 1k
b ��
k1k
a��k
The component f2 corresponds to the following diagram.
k
1k
��
1k
b��1k
a ��k
1k
��
k
1k
��
1k
b ��
k
1k
��
1k
a��
1k
b ��
k1k
a��
1k
��
k
1k
��
k
1k
��
k 1k
a ��
k1k
b��
1k
a ��k k 1k
b ��
k1k
a��
1k
b ��
k1k
a��k k
Proposition 3.1.3. Let u,w and f = fu,w be as above. Then the functor
F = (M(u),−)/ im(f,−)
74 CHAPTER 3. CB-RANK AND KG-DIMENSION
is a serial functor and the finitely presented subfunctors of F correspond to
• the interval [u,w) = {y ∈ H1(x) | u ≤ y < w} in H1(x) whenever σ(u) = −1
and
• the interval [u−,w) = {y ∈ H−1(x) | u− ≤ y < w} in H−1(x) whenever σ(u) = 1.
Proof. We give a proof for the case where σ(u) = −1, the case where σ(u) = 1 is
completely analogous.
Let G ⊆ F be a finitely presented subfunctor of F . Then, by Corollary 1.1.3,
G = im([ g
f
],−)/ im(f,−) for some g ≥ f in LM(u). That is, there is some morphism
t such that f = tg. We will show that[ gf
]∼[hf
]in LM(u) where h : M(u)→M(y) is
the graph map induced by u ≤ y < w in H1(x). Clearly any two distinct morphisms
of this from will yield distinct functors and so it suffices to show that all subfunctors
G are of this form.
Let g =n∑i=1
kigi where 0 6= ki ∈ k and gi is a graph map (such a decomposition
must exist by the results in Section 2.4.3) for each 1 ≤ i ≤ n.
First we show that we may assume that gi is not a morphism from a string module
to a band module for any 1 ≤ i ≤ n. By Lemma 1.1.5, it suffices to show that f ≥ gi
for any such gi : M(u) → B(b,M). This is immediate from the description of the
graph maps from string modules to band modules. Suppose v is the string associated
to gi. Then v is a factor substring of u and an image substring of ∞b∞. If u is an
image substring of u+ (i.e. we are in the first case considered in the construction of
Auslander-Reiten sequences with two middle terms in Section 2.4.1), then v is a factor
substring of u+ and so gi ≤ f1 ≤ f in LM(u). If u+ is a factor substring of u, then by
the definition of u+, v must still be a factor substring of u+ and gi ≤ f1 ≤ f . We may
then apply Lemma 1.1.5.
So, without loss of generality, we may assume that M =m⊕j=1
M(uj ) where uj is a
finite string for each 1 ≤ j ≤ m. Next we show that for any gi : M(u) → M(uj) with
1 ≤ i ≤ n and 1 ≤ j ≤ m, either gi is induced by uj ≤ u in H1(x) or gi ≤ f . So
suppose gi is not induced by the ordering in H1(x) and let v be the string associated
to gi. If u = v2vv1 with the length of v1 non-zero, then an argument similar to the
argument given for band modules yields that gi ≤ f1 ≤ f . If u = v2v and uj = y2vy1,
then the length of y1 must be non-zero since we have assumed that gi is not induced by
3.1. THE CANTOR-BENDIXSON RANK OF POINTS 75
the ordering on H1(x). As v is an image substring of uj, the last letter of y1 is direct.
Therefore u+ must be obtained from u by adding a hook, but then there must be a
factor substring x of u+ containing v such that x is an image substring of uj. That is
gi ≤ f1 ≤ f .
It follows that for each gi : M(u) → M(uj) we have that uj ∈ H1(u) and gi is the
graph map induced by the ordering u ≤ uj. Clearly, if w ≤ uj, then gi ≤ f2 ≤ f so, by
Lemma 1.1.5, we may assume uj ∈ [u,w). Moreover, the graph map M(u) → M(uj)
induced by u ≤ uj is unique and so we may assume that m = n and g =
[k1g1
...kngn
].
Finally, sinceH1(x) is a linear ordering, there is a minimum element ui of {u1, . . . , un}
with respect to this ordering and so gi ≥ gj for 1 ≤ j ≤ n. Without loss of gener-
ality, suppose u1 is the minimum element. Then it follows from Lemma 1.1.6 that[ gf
]∼[ g1f
]in LM(u) as required.
Corollary 3.1.4. Let F be as in Proposition 3.1.3, then
• (F ) = {C(y) | y ∈ H1(x) such that u ≤ y < w} whenever σ(u) = −1 and
• (F ) = {C(y) | y ∈ H−1(x) such that u− ≤ y < w} whenever σ(u) = 1
where C(y) is the indecomposable pure-injective module associated with the string y.
Proof. Combine the argument in the proof of Propositon 3.1.3 with Lemma 2.4.18.
Let u be a left N-string or a Z-string, then u = u2u1 with u2 = ∞b for some b ∈ Ba.
This band b is uniquely determined by u. As b is a vertex in QBa, we define the left
indent of u to be the length of the maximal length path in QBa ending at b. If u is
a right N-string or Z-string, then define the right indent of u to be the left indent
of u−. If u is a left (respectively right) N-string then we will use the term indent to
refer to the left (respectively right) indent of u.
Theorem 3.1.5. Let y be an N-string with indent n, then the Cantor-Bendixson rank
of C(y) is n + 1 where C(y) is the indecomposable infinite-dimensional pure-injective
A-module associated to y.
Proof. Without loss of generality we assume that y is a left N-string with σ(y) = −1
and let x = s(y). There is some b ∈ Ba such that y = ∞bx for some finite string x .
Let u = bx and w = ◦bx where ◦b is the string obtained from b by removing the last
76 CHAPTER 3. CB-RANK AND KG-DIMENSION
letter. Since b is a band, this last letter is direct and u < w in H1(x). The interval
contains all strings of the form vu where v is a (possibly infinite) string.
We proceed by induction on the indent n of y . Suppose n = 0. Then for every
vu ∈ [u,w ], the string y is finite unless vu = y . Otherwise there is a path in QBa starting
at b contradicting our assumption that n = 0. Thus, if F = (M(u),−)/ im(fu,w ,−),
then by Corollary 3.1.4 and Proposition 3.1.1 we have
(F ) ∩ Zg(1) = {C(y)}.
Now suppose the statement is true for all string modules C(x ) where x has indent
less than n and suppose y has indent n. Then the infinite strings in [u,w ] are of the
form ∞cvu for some band c ∈ Ba and finite string v . Then, unless ∞cvu = y , the
indent of ∞cvu must be strictly less than n and so, by our induction hypothesis, the
Cantor-Bandixson rank of C(∞cvu) is less than or equal to n. Moreover, all strings
of this form are in [u,w ] so there are infinitely many of Cantor-Bendixson rank n. It
follows that we have
(F ) ∩ Zg(n+1) = {C(y)}
since otherwise we would contradict the compactness of Zg(n) and so the Cantor-
Bendixson rank of C(y) is n+ 1.
Corollary 3.1.6. 1. Let F = (M(u),−)/ im(fu,w ,−) where u < w in H1(x) for
some x ∈ Q0. Then the m-dimension of the interval [u,w ] in H1(x) is equal to
the Krull-Gabriel dimension of F and is m+ 1 where m is the maximum indent
of a string in [u,w ].
2. Let F = (M(u),−)/ im(fu,w ,−) where u− < w in H−1(x) for some x ∈ Q0. Then
the m-dimension of the interval [u−,w ] in H−1(x) is equal to the Krull-Gabriel
dimension of F and is m + 1 where m is the maximum indent of a string in
[u−,w ].
Example 3.1.7. The morphism fu,w defined in Example 3.1.2 gives rise to a functor
F as in the proof of Proposition 3.1.3. Then the interval [u,w ] in H1(x) is the linear
poset
ba−b−ab−a < (ba−)2b−ab−a < (ba−)3b−ab−a < · · · < a−(ba−)2b−ab−a < a−ba−b−ab−a.
3.1. THE CANTOR-BENDIXSON RANK OF POINTS 77
Then it is clear that y = ∞(ba−)b−ab−a is the only infinite string in the interval [u,w ]
in H1(x). Thus (F ) ∩ Zg(1) = {C(y)} and so CB(C(y)) = 1.
3.1.2 The Cantor-Bendixson rank of Z-string modules
Consider an almost periodic Z-string y = ∞bv2v1c∞ where ∞b is the left maximal
periodic substring of y and c∞ is the right maximal periodic substring of y . Let
u = bv2v1c and w = ◦bv2v1c◦ where ◦b is the string obtained from b by removing the
last letter and c◦ is the string obtained from c by removing the first letter. Since c
and b are bands, the last letter of b is direct and the first letter of c is inverse so, if
x = e(v1) = s(v2), then bv2 <◦bv2 in H1(x) and v1c < v1c◦ in H−1(x). That is, u < w
in H(x).
Let
gy = [ g1g2 ] : M(u)→M(◦bv2v1c)⊕M(bv2v1c◦)
where g1 and g2 are induced by the posets H1(x) and H−1(x) respectively.
Proposition 3.1.8. Let y , u,w and g = gy be as above. Then the finitely presented
subfunctors of G = (M(u),−)/ im(g,−) are of the form
im(h,−)/ im(g,−)
for h =
[ h1...hm
]: M(u)→
k⊕j=1
M(xj) where xj = x2jx1j for x2j ∈ [bv2,◦bv2) in H1(x) and
x1j ∈ [v1c, v1c◦) in H−1(x) for each 1 ≤ j ≤ m.
Proof. Let H ⊆ G be a finitely presented subfunctor of G. Then by Lemma 1.1.4
H = im([
hg
],−)/ im(g,−) for some h ≥ g in LM(u). So let h =
n∑i=1
kihi : M(u)→ M
be the unique decomposition of h into a linear combination of pairwise different graph
maps hi with 0 6= ki ∈ k for each 1 ≤ i ≤ n.
First note that, by Lemma 1.1.5, we can assume that the finite string associated
to hi is u since otherwise f ≥ hi. If hi is a graph map from a string module to a band
module B(d , N), then ∞d∞ contains the string b1br where b = br . . . b1 and c1cs where
c = cs · · · c1 because u must be closed under successors in ∞d∞. But this contradicts
Proposition 2 in [50, Sec. 11].
So, without loss of generality, assume that M =m⊕j=1
M(xj) for finite strings xj with
1 ≤ j ≤ m and each hi : M(u) → M(xj) has u as its associated string. Suppose for
78 CHAPTER 3. CB-RANK AND KG-DIMENSION
some xj there is some 1 ≤ i1 < i2 ≤ n such that we have hi1 : M(u) → M(xj) and
hi2 : M(u) → M(xj). Since hi1 and hi2 are distinct graph maps, xj must contain two
distinct copies of u. But then there exists a string x 6= bi for any i > 0 with bxb a
well-defined string. By [54, Lem. 4.2], this is impossible. Thus h =
[ k1h1...
kmhm
]and by
[47, Lem. 2.5], h ∼[ h1
...hm
]as required.
Corollary 3.1.9. Let y , u, w and G be as in Proposition 3.1.8. Then
(G) = {C(x ) | u is an image substring of x }
where C(x ) is the indecomposable pure-injective module associated with the (possibly
infinite) string x .
Proof. Combine the argument in the proof of Proposition 3.1.8 with Lemma 2.4.18.
Theorem 3.1.10. Let y be a Z-string over A with left indent m and right indent
n. The Cantor-Bendixson rank of the module C(y) is m + n + 2 where C(y) is the
indecomposable infinite-dimensional pure-injective A-module associated to y.
Proof. Let y , u,w and G be as in Proposition 3.1.8. We proceed by induction on m+n.
Suppose m = n = 0. Then the strings corresponding to modules in (G) are either
equal to y , finite or N-strings with indent 0. By Theorem 3.1.5
(G) ∩ Zg(2) = {C(y)}
since there are infinitely many N-string modules C in (G) with CB(C) = 1 so if
CB(C(y)) = 1, then this would contradict the compactness of Zg(1). And so we have
CB(C(y)) = 2.
Suppose the statement is true for all Z-strings with left indent p and right indent
q such that p + q < m + n. Then by Theorem 3.1.5 all N-string modules in (G) have
Cantor-Bendixson rank less than or equal to max{m,n}+ 1 < m+ n+ 2. Moreover,
since every string associated to an module in (G) contains bv2v1c, we have that any
Z-string module in (G) is either equal to C(y) or has Cantor-Bendixson rank equal to
p + q + 2 < m + n + 2 for some left indent p ≤ m and right indent q ≤ n such that
not both p = m and q = n hold. Since Zg(m+n+1) is compact and there are infinitely
many Z-string modules with Cantor-Bendixson rank m+ n+ 1, we have
(G) ∩ Zg(m+n+2) = {C(y)}
3.1. THE CANTOR-BENDIXSON RANK OF POINTS 79
and so CB(C(y)) = m+ n+ 2.
Corollary 3.1.11. Let y , u, w and G be as in Proposition 3.1.8 and suppose that y has
left indent m and right indent n. Then the Krull-Gabriel dimension of G is m+n+2.
Example 3.1.12. Consider the algebra Λ3 given by the quiver
1b1
66a1((2
c1 // 3b2
66a2((4
c2 // 5b3
66a3((6
with relations c1b1 = b2c1 = c2b2 = b3c2 = 0. Let y = ∞(b2a−2 )c−2 a
−3 (b−3 a
−3 )∞. The
bridge quiver looks like
b1a−1
c−1 a−2 // b2a
−2
c−2 a−3 // b3a
−3
a3b−3
a3c2 // a2b−2
a2c1 // a1b−1
so the left indent of y is 1 and the right indent of y is 0.
By constructing the functor G as in the proof of Theorem 3.1.10 we obtain an
open set of Zg consisting of the string modules in which the finite string module
M(b2a−2 c−2 a−3 b3a
−3 ) embeds. We will only consider the Z-string modules in (G) since
they will attain the greatest rank. There is an infinite family
{xn = ∞(b1a−1 )c−1 a
−2 (b2a
−2 )nc−2 a
−3 (b3a
−3 )∞ | n ∈ N}
such that C(xn) ∈ (G) for each n ∈ N. These correspond to maximal paths in QBa
and so CB(C(xn)) = 2 for each n ∈ N. The only other Z-string module in (G) is C(y)
and so CB(C(y)) = 3.
3.1.3 The Cantor-Bendixson rank of Prufer modules
Next we consider the Prufer modules in Zg. Let k ∈ k∗. Consider the morphism
fn : B(b,Mk,1) → B(b,Mk,n) taking the canonical basis element z(1)i in B(b,Mk,1) to
the canonical basis element z(1)i in B(b,Mk,n) for 1 ≤ i ≤ m. For n > 1, this is the
compositions fn = Fb(ιn−1) · · ·Fb(ι1) where ιi : Mk,i → Mk,i+1 is defined in Example
1.2.1 for i ∈ N.
Let v = v2bv1 be the substring of ∞b∞ of maximal length such that v1 is direct and
v2 is inverse. Let h : B(b,Mk,1) → M(v) be the (unique) graph map with z(1)m 7→ zv
where zv is the canonical basis element of M(v) between b and v1.
80 CHAPTER 3. CB-RANK AND KG-DIMENSION
Proposition 3.1.13. Let h : B(b,Mk,1)→M(v) be as above and consider the functor
H = (B(b,Mk,1),−)/ im(h,−). The finitely presented subfunctors of H are of the form
G = im ([ gh ] ,−) / im(h,−)
where g = [ g1g2 ] : B(b,Mk,1)→ N1 ⊕N2 with
1. the module N1 =m⊕i=1
M(ui) where ui contains v as a factor substring for 1 ≤ i ≤
m and g1 =n∑j=1
kjg1j with g1j : B(b,Mk,1) → M(ui) is induced by ∞b∞ < ui < v
in H(s(b)); and
2. the module N2 = B(b,Mk,n) for some n ≥ 1 and g2 = fn.
Proof. By Lemma 1.1.4, every finitely presented subfunctor G ⊆ H is of the form
G = im ([ gh ] ,−) / im(h,−)
for some g : B(b,Mk,1) → N with g ≤ h. Let g = [ g1g2 ] : B(b,Mk,1) → N1 ⊕N2 where
N ∼= N1⊕N2 and N1 is a direct sum of string modules and N2 is a direct sum of band
modules.
We begin by considering g2. Let g2 =t2∑i=1
kig2i be its decomposition into a linear
combination of graph maps. If there exists some g2i : B(b,Mk,1)→ B(c, N) that is not
in the image of Fb , then there is some finite factor substring of u of ∞b∞ associated
to g2i. Moreover, it must contain v as a factor substring since ∞b∞ < u < v but this
means that c = b or c = b− because there is at most one band starting with b1 (see
[50]). But then u is a factor substring and an image substring of ∞b∞ containing b
which is impossible. So every g2i is in the image of Fb and, moreover, we must have
g2 =
[k1g21
...ktg2t2
]since g2i = fni for some ni ≥ 1 for each 1 ≤ i ≤ t2 is the unique
morphism B(b,Mk,1) → B(b,Mk,n) (up to scalar multiplication) in the image of Fb .
Let ni be the least integer such that g2i = fni . Then g2i ≤ kjg2j for all 1 ≤ j ≤ t2 and
so by Lemma 1.1.6, we may assume that g2 = g2j as required.
Now consider g1 : B(b,Mk,1) → N1 and let g1 =t1∑i=1
kig1i be the decomposition
into a linear combination of graph maps. Suppose N1 =m1⊕j=1
M(uj) and consider
g1i : B(b,Mk,1) → M(uj). Then by Lemma 1.1.5, we may assume g1i < h and so
∞b∞ ≤ uj ≤ v and uj must therefore contain v as a factor substring. Thus g1 is of the
form described in (1).
3.1. THE CANTOR-BENDIXSON RANK OF POINTS 81
Corollary 3.1.14. Let H be as in Proposition 3.1.13. Then
(H) = {B(b,Mk,i) | i ≥ 1} ∪ {B(b,Mk,∞)} ∪ {C(u) | ∞b∞ < u < v in H(s(b))}.
where C(u) is the indecomposable pure-injective module associated to the (possibly
infinite) string u.
Proof. Combine the proof of Proposition 3.1.13 with Proposition 2.4.18.
Let u = ∞bv be a left N-string or a Z-string. Then the left upper-indent of u is
the maximal length of a path un . . . u1 in QBa ending at b such that b < u1 in H1(x)
and x = s(b) = s(u1). The left lower-indent of u is the maximal length of a path
un . . . u1 in QBa ending at b such that u1 < b in H1(x).
Let u be a right N-string or a Z-string. The right upper-indent and right
lower-indent of u is defined to be the left upper-indent and left lower indent of u−
respectively.
Theorem 3.1.15. The Cantor-Bendixson rank of B(b,Mk,∞) for a band b is n+m+1
where n is the left upper-indent of ∞b∞ and m is the right upper-indent of ∞b∞.
Proof. Consider (H) and note that in the preceding sections we have calculated the
Cantor-Bendixson rank of all the modules in this open set apart from the Prufer
module. The modules of highest Cantor-Bendixson rank (apart from B(b,Mk,∞)) are
Z-string modules with left indent n − 1 and right indent m − 1. By Theorem 3.1.10,
these Z-string modules have Cantor-Bendixson rank m+ n. Since there are infinitely
many of them and Zg(m+n) is compact, it follows that (H)∩Zg(m+n+1) = {B(b,Mk,∞)}
and so the CB(B(b,Mk,∞)) = m+ n+ 1.
3.1.4 The Cantor-Bendixson rank of adic modules
We will use elementary duality to apply the results about Prufer modules directly to
the adic modules. We have been considering left modules over the path algebra A
of the bound quiver (Q, I). To consider right A-modules we can consider left Aop
-
modules. The algebra Aop
is obtained by taking the path algebra over the opposite
quiver Qop
with Qop
0 = Q0 and Qop
1 = {aop: j → i | a : i → j ∈ Q1}; the relations are
reversed in the obvious way. Then Aop
is a domestic string algebra so all of the results
we have proved so far can be applied to right A-modules.
82 CHAPTER 3. CB-RANK AND KG-DIMENSION
Let u = um . . . u1 be a string and define the opposite string uop= u
op
1 . . . uop
m by
extending the (−)op
operation to formal inverses of arrows. Note that if b is a band,
then bopis a cyclic rotation of a band over A
op.
The definitions and results referred to in the following proposition can be found in
Section 1.5.
Proposition 3.1.16. Elementary duality gives a homeomorphism D : AZg → ZgA.
The following list shows how D acts on infinite-dimensional modules in AZg.
1. Let b be a band. The Prufer modules over b are dual to the adic modules over
a band cyclically equivalent to bopand the adic modules over b are dual to the
Prufer modules over a band cyclically equivalent to bop. The generic module over
b is dual to the generic module over a band cyclically equivalent to bop.
2. Let u ∈ Con. Then M(u) is dual to N(uop) and uop
is an expanding string.
3. Let u ∈ Exp. Then N(u) is dual to M(uop) and uop
is a contracting string.
4. Let u ∈ Mix. Then L(u) is dual to the mixed module R(uop).
Proof. 1. Let b be a band and let 0 6= k ∈ k. An easy calculation yields that
B(b,Mi,k)∗ ∼= B(c,Mi,k−1) for each i ≥ 1 where c is a band over A
opthat is some
cyclic rotation of bop. Consider the left A-module B(b,M∞,k) i.e. the Prufer
module associated to b. ThenB(b,M∞,k) = lim−→ iB(b,Mi,k) and since Homk(−,k)
sends colimits in A-Mod to limits in Mod-A, it follows that B(b,M∞,k)∗ is equal
to B(c,M−∞,k−1). So, by Corollary 1.5.6, D(B(b,M∞,k)) = B(c,M−∞,k−1) and
D(B(c,M−∞,k−1)) = B(b,M∞,k).
Finally, modules M with finite endolength are always reflexive and D(M) also
has finite endolength (see, for example, [44, Cor. 5.4.17]) and so, if we consider
the closed subset given by the image of Fb , we can apply Corollary 1.5.3 and
conclude that D(B(b, G)) = B(c, G) and D(B(c, G)) = B(b, G) where G is the
generic module over k[T, T−1].
2. It is immediate that if u = ∞bv is a contracting N-string, then uop is an expanding
N-string. Also, it follows directly from the definitions that M(biv)∗ ∼= M((biv)op
)
3.1. THE CANTOR-BENDIXSON RANK OF POINTS 83
for each i ≥ 1. Since Homk(−,k) sends colimits to limits, we have
M(u)∗ ∼= lim←− iM((biv)op
) ∼= N(uop
).
Therefore, by Corollary 1.5.3, D(M(u)) = N(uop).
Similarly u = ∞bvc∞ then M(u) = lim−→ iM(ibvci) and so by the same argument
D(M(u)) = N(uop) and D(N(uop
)) = M(u).
3. This follows from the arguments in the proof of 2..
4. Let u = ∞bvc∞ ∈ Mix. Then L(u) = lim−→ iN(∞bvci) so,
L(u)∗ = lim←− iN(∞bvci)∗ = lim←− iM((∞bvci)op
) = R(uop
).
Again, it follows that D(L(u)) = R(uop) and D(R(uop
)) = L(u).
Theorem 3.1.17. The Cantor-Bendixson rank of B(b,M−∞) for a band b is m+n+1
where n is the left lower-indent of ∞b∞ and m is the right lower-indent of ∞b∞.
Proof. We consider the Prufer module B(b ′, N∞) over Aop
such that B(b ′, N∞)∗ is
equal to B(b,M−∞). Then
(H) = {B(c, Ni) | i ≥ 1} ∪ {B(c, N∞)} ∪ {C(u) | ∞(c)∞ < u < v in H+(s(c))}
where C(u) is the indecomposable pure-injective module associated to the (possibly
infinite) string u and v = v2cv1 as defined at the beginning of the previous section. It
is immediate from Proposition 3.1.16 that
(dH) = {B(b,Mi) | i ≥ 1} ∪ {B(b,M−∞)} ∪ {C(uop
) | vop
< uop
< ∞b∞ in H+(s(b))}.
Thus the modules in (dH) with greatest Cantor-Bendixson rank are Z-string modules
C(w) with left lower-indent m−1 and right lower-indent n−1, so by Theorem 3.1.10,
CB(C(w)) = m+ n. Since there are infinitely many such modules, it follows that the
Cantor-Bendixson rank of B(b,M−∞) is m+ n+ 1.
84 CHAPTER 3. CB-RANK AND KG-DIMENSION
3.1.5 The Cantor-Bendixson rank of generic modules
Let b ∈ Ba, u = b and v = v2bv1 as described in Section 3.1.3. Let g : M(u) → M(v)
be the graph map induced by u < v in H(x) for some x ∈ Q0.
Proposition 3.1.18. Let k be as above and consider K = (M(u),−)/ im(g,−). Then
the finitely presented subfunctors F of K are of the form F = im([
fg
],−)/ im(g,−)
where f =n∑i=1
kifi with 0 6= ki ∈ k and fi a graph map with associated string u. Also
(K) = {B(b,Ml,i) | i ∈ N∪{∞,−∞}}∪{M(w) | u ≤ w < v in H(s(b))}∪{B(b, G)}.
Proof. By Lemma 1.1.4 and Lemma 1.1.5, the finitely presented subfunctors F of K
are of the form F = im([
fk
],−)/ im(k,−) where f ≥ k and if f =
n∑i=1
kifi is the
unique decomposition of f into a linear combination of graph maps with ki 6= 0 for
all 1 ≤ i ≤ n, then fi ≥ k for each 1 ≤ i ≤ n. The description of graph maps implies
that the graph maps with fi ≥ k must have u as the associated string.
Similarly, the description open set (K) is immediate from the description of graph
maps. In particular, there can be no band modules B(c,M) with c 6= b and c 6= b−
since b cannot be an image substring of ∞(c)∞.
Theorem 3.1.19. Let b ∈ Ba. The Cantor-Bendixson rank of the generic module
B(b, G) is m+ 2 where m is the maximal length of a path in QBa passing through b.
Proof. If l is the left indent of ∞b∞ and r is the right indent of ∞b∞, then m = r + l.
The modules of highest Cantor-Bendixson rank in (K) (apart from B(b, G)) are Z-
string modules with left indent l and right indent r − 1 (or with left indent l − 1
and right indent r). By Theorem 3.1.10, these modules have Cantor-Bendixson rank
r + l + 1 = m+ 1. Since there are infinitely many of them and Zg(m+1) is compact, it
follows that CB(B(b, G)) = m+ 2.
3.2 The Cantor-Bendixson rank of the Ziegler spec-
trum and Krull-Gabriel dimension of the func-
tor category
It follows immediately from the previous sections that we have the following theorem.
3.2. THE CB RANK AND KG DIMENSION OF A STRING ALGEBRA 85
Theorem 3.2.1. Let A be a domestic string algebra and let m be the maximum length
of a path in the bridge quiver QBa. Then the Krull-Gabriel dimension of (A-mod,Ab)fp
is equal to the Cantor-Bendixson rank of AZg and is equal to m+ 2.
Proof. By Theorem 2.5.2 and Remark 2.5.4 the Cantor-Bendixson rank and the Krull-
Gabriel dimension are equal. Moreover, this value is given by the maximum rank of
the points in AZg. Thus it follows from Theorems 3.1.5, 3.1.10, 3.1.15, 3.1.17 and
3.1.19 that the Krull-Gabriel dimension and Cantor-Bendixson rank are both equal to
m+ 2.
Corollary 3.2.2. Conjecture 1.4.6 holds for domestic string algebras.
Proof. Compare the above theorem with Theorem 2.5.7.
Part II
The derived category
86
Chapter 4
The bounded derived category of a
gentle algebra
In this chapter we will describe the indecomposable objects in the bounded derived
category of a gentle algebra A. For the definition of a gentle algebra see Section 2.1.
The classification was first given in [10]; we follow Bekket and Merklen in describing
the indecomposable objects in Kb,−(A-proj) and then referring to the following well-
known equivalence of categories (see, for example, [28, Prop. 6.3.1]).
Kb,−(A-proj) ' Db(A-mod).
As with the module category of a string algebra, the indecomposable objects in
Kb,−(A-proj) correspond to combinatorial objects that resemble strings and bands
and the structure of the complex reflects the structure of the ‘string’ or ‘band’. We
begin this chapter by defining homotopy strings and homotopy bands; as before, these
combinatorial objects have letters that arise from arrows in the quiver but they also
carry data that indicates which degree of the corresponding complex the letter should
sit in. The remainder of the chapter will be dedicated to describing the construction
of the indecomposable objects in Kb,−(A-proj), that is string and band complexes.
Remark 4.0.3. In this second part of the thesis we look at certain triangulated cate-
gories associated to the categories of modules over a ring R; that is, derived categories
and homotopy categories. In practice we will only ever be working directly in homotopy
categories of projective modules. These categories have, as their objects, complexes
of projective modules and, as their morphisms, morphisms of chain complexes up to
87
88 CHAPTER 4. THE DERIVED CATEGORY OF A GENTLE ALGEBRA
homotopy equivalence. To reduce the amount of cumbersome notation, we will make
use of the following abbreviations:
• D := D(R-Mod) denotes the derived category of R-Mod.
• Db := Db(R-mod) denotes the bounded derived category of R-mod.
• K := K(R-Proj) denotes the (unbounded) homotopy category of R-Proj.
• Kb := Kb(R-proj) denotes the homotopy category of bounded complexes of
finitely generated projective R-modules.
• Kb,− := Kb,−(R-proj) denotes the homotopy category of right bounded com-
plexes of finitely generated projective R-modules whose cohomology is bounded.
• Cb,− := Cb,−(R-proj) denotes the category of right bounded complexes of finitely
generated projective R-modules whose cohomology is bounded.
Clearly, the drawback of such abbreviations is that the ring R underlying each
category is no longer indicated; we will fix the ring within each chapter. For the
duration of Chapter 4 and the first part of Chapter 5 (up to and including Section
5.2) we will be considering an arbitrary gentle algebra A. From Section 5.3 until the
end of the thesis we will be considering a fixed derived-discrete algebra Λ of infinite
representation type.
4.1 Homotopy strings and homotopy bands
Throughout this section A = kQ/I will be a gentle algebra over an algebraically closed
field. The letters of the homotopy strings and homotopy bands will be given by direct
and inverse strings over A. For the relevant definitions, see Section 2.2.
4.1.1 Homotopy strings
The definition of a homotopy string can be easier to process when the reader un-
derstands the construction of the string complex to which it corresponds. Therefore
we will include a running example that gives an indication of the construction of the
corresponding string complex; the formal definition is given in Section 4.2.
4.1. HOMOTOPY STRINGS AND HOMOTOPY BANDS 89
Example 4.1.1. Consider the gentle algebra given by the quiver
1
b
��
3f
��0
a
^^
d ��2
c
@@
4
e
OO
with relations ba = cb = ac = df = fe = ed = 0.
We say that a triple (w ,m, n) is a homotopy letter (of positive length) if w
is a direct or inverse string and m,n ∈ Z such that n =
m+ 1 if w is direct
m− 1 if w is inverse.
The key observation for understanding these definitions is the following.
Observation 4.1.2. Let A be a gentle algebra. Then there is a natural bijection
{Paths p : x y in Q} ←→ {Basis elements of HomA-mod(P (y), P (x))}
where P (x), P (y) denote the projective covers of the simple at x and y in Q0 respec-
tively.
Recall that there are bases of P (x) and P (y) corresponding to paths starting at
x and y respectively. Let u ∈ P (y) be such a basis element, then up ∈ P (x). The
bijection is given by taking the path p to the morphism p 7→ up. For the remainder of
this document we will consider these paths to be direct strings and we will identify the
morphism p 7→ up with the string p. Moreover, paths of length zero will be represented
by 1 (this should be thought of as multiplication by the identity in k).
Remark 4.1.3. Since we read paths from right to left, we will compose morphisms
between projective modules from left to right. That is, we will use the following
convention for the presentation of matrices and matrix multiplication: all matrices
will be transposed and if A and B are such matrices, then AB will mean “do A
then do B”. For example if we consider the algebra given in Example 4.1.1. Then
the morphisms between projective modules in the following are written as transposed
matrices.
P (1)⊕ P (4)( ad )−→ P (0)
( f c )−→ P (3)⊕ P (2)
To see why this notation is preferable consider that the multiplication is then written
as ( ad ) ( f c ) =(af acdf dc
)=(af 00 dc
).
90 CHAPTER 4. THE DERIVED CATEGORY OF A GENTLE ALGEBRA
Example 4.1.4. Consider the algebra given in Example 4.1.1. Then (af, 0, 1) is a
homotopy letter. The integers m and n refer to degrees of the corresponding string
complex. For example, the homotopy letter (af, 0, 1) gives rise to a complex which is
only non-zero in degrees 0 and 1 and there is one non-zero differential map given by
the path af .
A homotopy string (of length b > 0) is a triple W = (wb · wb−1 · . . . · w1,m, n)
where w1, . . . ,wb are direct or inverse strings and m,n ∈ Z such that W is produced
as a result of the following induction: First we take homotopy letters to be homotopy
strings and, if W = (wb · wb−1 · . . . · w1,m, n) and U = (ua · ua−1 · . . . · u1, i, j) are
homotopy strings, then their concatenation W ◦U = (wb · . . . · w1 · ua · . . . · u1,m, j) is
a homotopy string whenever
1. i = n;
2. s(w1) = e(ua);
3. if w1 and ua are both direct (respectively both inverse) then w1ua ∈ I (respec-
tively (w1ua)− ∈ I; and
4. if one of w1 and ua is direct and the other is inverse, then u 6= w− where u is the
last letter of ua and w is the first letter of w1.
Example 4.1.5. Consider the algebra given in Example 4.1.1. Then (b · af, 0, 3) and
(e− · f− · c, 2, 1) are both homotopy strings. Again, the integers indicate degrees of the
complex. For example, the complex arising from (b · af, 1, 3) is the following.
P (2) b // P (1)af // P (3)
where P (2) is in degree 1, P (1) is in degree 2 and P (3) is in degree 3. The non-zero
differentials are given by ‘composition with the paths b and af ’; thus the relation
between b and af means that the differential squares to zero.
Similarly, the complex arising from (e− · f− · c, 2, 1) has the following non-zero
degrees 0, 1 and 2.
P (0)( c f ) // P (2)⊕ P (3)
( 0e )// P (4)
4.1. HOMOTOPY STRINGS AND HOMOTOPY BANDS 91
We also introduce homotopy strings (of length zero). These are triples (1t,m,m)
where m ∈ Z and 1t is the string of length zero associated to the vertex t ∈ Q0
(from now on we will only consider one string of length zero for each vertex in
the quiver). We extend the functions s and e to homotopy strings in the obvious
way. That is s(wb · · · · · w1,m, n) = s(w1), e(wb · . . . · w1,m, n) = e(wb) and finally
s(1t,m,m) = e(1t,m,m) = t.
Next we define composition of homotopy strings. Let
W = (wb · wb−1 · . . . · w1,m, n) and U = (ua · ua−1 · . . . · u1, i, j)
be homotopy strings such that s(W ) = e(U) and n = i. Then the composition WU
is a defined to be W ◦ U as above, or WU = (wb · . . . · w1ua · . . . · u1,m, j) where w1ua
is either a direct or an inverse string. If U = (ua · ua−1 · . . . · u1, i, j) is a homotopy
string, then we can compose (1t,m,m) to the left of U if i = m and e(U) = t. We
can compose (1t,m,m) to the right of U if j = m and s(U) = t. In both cases, the
resulting homotopy string is U.
For a homotopy string W = (wb · . . . · w1,m, n) of length b > 0, we define the
inverse of W to be the homotopy string W − := (w−1 · . . . · w−b , n,m). If (1t,m,m)
is a homotopy string of length zero, then the inverse homotopy string is defined to be
(1t,m,m)− := (1t,m,m).
To each homotopy string W = (wb · . . . · w1,m, n) of length b > 0, we attach the
diagram below; we will refer to it as the unfolded diagram of W .
mb+1 mb m2 m1
•w∗b • · · · •
w∗1 •
Where w∗i is the direct string out of {wi,w−i }, mb+1 = m, m1 = n and
mi+1 =
mi − 1 if wi is direct
mi + 1 if wi is inverse.
The line •w∗i • represents an arrow •
w∗i // • when wi is direct and an arrow
• •w∗ioo when wi is inverse.
Example 4.1.6. Consider the algebra given in Example 4.1.1. The homotopy string
(e− · f− · c · b · af, 2, 3) is the concatenation of the strings given in Example 4.1.5 and
92 CHAPTER 4. THE DERIVED CATEGORY OF A GENTLE ALGEBRA
has the following unfolded diagram.
2 1 0 1 2 3
• •eoo •foo c // • b // • af // •
The string complex given by (e− · f− · c · b · af, 2, 3) can be found in Example 4.2.2.
To each homotopy string (1t,m,m) of length zero, we associate the unfolded dia-
gram below.
m•
4.1.2 Homotopy bands
A homotopy string W = (wb · . . . · w1,m, n) of length b > 0 is called a homotopy
band if
1. s(W ) = e(W );
2. m = n;
3. one of w1 and wb is direct and the other is inverse; and
4. W is not a proper power of another homotopy string satisfying (1) and (2).
The extra restrictions on the band mean that the first letter and the last letter end
in the same vertex Q, but also that the homotopy string starts and ends in the same
degree of the complex. This means that we can construct a complex in which the ends
of the string are identified This can be seen in the following example.
Example 4.1.7. Consider the algebra given in Example 4.1.1. Then the homotopy
string (d− · e− ·d− · c · b ·a, 0, 0) is a homotopy band. The corresponding string complex
is the following (the matrices are transposed, see Remark 4.1.3).
P (0)( c f ) // P (2)⊕ P (3)
( b 00 e )// P (1)⊕ P (4)
( a 00 d )// P (0)⊕ P (0)
The corresponding band complex is given in Example 4.2.6; the definition of a ho-
motopy band allows us to identify the copies of P (0) and to adjust the differential
accordingly.
4.1. HOMOTOPY STRINGS AND HOMOTOPY BANDS 93
To each homotopy band W = (wb · . . . ·w1,m, n) we associate the following infinite
repeating unfolded diagram.
mb+1 mb m2 m1
. . .w∗1 •
w∗b • · · · •w∗1 •
w∗b. . .
For each 1 ≤ i ≤ b, we take mi, w∗i and •w∗i • to be as in the definition of an
unfolded homotopy string above.
Example 4.1.8. Consider the algebra given in Example 4.1.1 and the homotopy band
(d− · e− · d− · c · b · a, 0, 0). The unfolded diagram is as follows.
0 −1 −2 −3 −2 −1
. . . a // • •doo •eoo •doo c // • b // • a // . . .
4.1.3 Resolvable homotopy strings
The homotopy strings and homotopy bands we have seen so far give rise to bounded
complexes. The final class of homotopy strings give rise to complexes that are bounded
in cohomology but are unbounded to the left.
Let C(A) be the set of arrows a ∈ Q1 such that there is a path aa1 . . . at in Q with
s(at) = e(a), aa1 ∈ I and aiai+1 ∈ I for all 1 ≤ i < t. Note that C(A) is non-empty if
and only if A has infinite global dimension.
Let W = (wb · . . . · w1,m, n) be a homotopy string of length b > 0 such that W is
the concatenation of the following homotopy letters:
(wb,m = mb, nb), (wb−1,mb−1, nb−1), . . . , (w1,m1, n = n1).
Then W is left resolvable if wb is direct, m ≤ mi, ni for all 1 ≤ i ≤ b and there
exists a ∈ C(A) such that (a ·wb · . . . ·w1,m− 1, n) is a homotopy string. We say that
a resolves W . If, in addition, wb is a string of length > 1, then we say that W is
primitive left resolvable. We say that W is (primitive) right resolvable if W −
is (primitive) left resolvable. If W is both (primitive) left resolvable and (primitive)
right resolvable then we say that W is (primitive) two-sided resolvable.
For each primitive left resolvable string W = (wb · . . . · w1,m, n), there is a unique
cyclic path al...a1 with ai+1ai ∈ I for each 1 ≤ i < l such that a1 resolves W . Consider
the sequence of homotopy strings
A1 = (a1,m− 1,m)
94 CHAPTER 4. THE DERIVED CATEGORY OF A GENTLE ALGEBRA
A2 = (a2 · a1,m− 2,m)
...
Al = (al · . . . · a1,m− l,m)
Al+1 = (a1 · al · . . . · a1,m− l − 1,m)
...
Then AiW is defined for each i ≥ 1 and we let ∞W denote the combinatorial limit of
this sequence. The corresponding unfolded diagram is below.
mb+3 mb+2 mb+1 mb m2 m1
. . . •a3 a2 • a1 •w∗b • · · · •
w∗1 •
Where mb+2 = mb+1− 1 and mb+3 = mb+1− 2 etc. We can define the strings W∞ and
∞W∞ for primitive right and two-sided resolvable strings in an analogous way.
Example 4.1.9. Consider the algebra given in Example 4.1.1. The homotopy string
W = (dc · b,−2, 0) is primitive left resolvable by e. The unfolded diagram of ∞W is
the following.
−5 −4 −3 −2 −1 0
. . . e // • d // • f // • e // • dc // • b // •
An explanation of the terminology ‘resolvable’ will be given in Section 4.2.1.
4.1.4 Equivalence relations
The homotopy strings and homotopy bands give rise to indecomposable complexes in
Kb,−. To obtain a parametrisation of the indecomposable objects in Kb,−, we must
consider equivalence classes of homotopy strings and homotopy bands.
Homotopy strings We say W∼−1U for finite homotopy strings U,W if and only
if W = U− or W = U. Let HSt be a fixed set of ∼−1-equivalence classes of
homotopy strings.
Homotopy bands We say that W∼rU for homotopy bands U,W if and only if W
is the concatenation of the following homotopy letters:
(wb,m = mb, nb), (wb−1,mb−1, nb−1), . . . , (w1,m1, n = n1)
4.2. INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES 95
and U is the concatenation of the following homotopy letters:
(wi,mi, ni), . . . , (w1,m1, n1), (wb,mb, nb), . . . , (wi+1,mi+1, ni+1)
for some 1 ≤ i < b.
We say that W∼bU for homotopy bands W , U if and only if W∼rU or W∼−1U.
Let HBa be a fixed set of representatives of ∼b-equivalence classes of homotopy
bands.
Resolvable homotopy strings Let L tRt T be the disjoint union of fixed sets of
representatives of ∼−1-equivalence classes of primitive left, right and two-sided
resolvable strings respectively. Then let
HRes := {W∞ | W ∈ R} ∪ {∞W | W ∈ L} ∪ {∞W∞ | W ∈ T }.
4.2 Indecomposable complexes
In this section we will describe the indecomposable objects in the bounded derived cat-
egory Kb,−(A-proj) where A is a gentle algebra. In analogy with the module category
of a string algebra, the objects will correspond to homotopy strings and homotopy
bands. We will reach the following theorem due to Bekkert and Merklen [10].
Theorem 4.2.1. There is a bijection
{Indecomposable objects in Db(A-mod)} ←→ HSt t (HBa× k∗ × N) t HRes.
Moreover, the perfect complexes (i.e. those contained in the canonical copy of Kb(A-proj))
are exactly those corresponding to the elements of HSt t (HBa× k∗ × N).
4.2.1 String complexes
Let W = (wb · . . . · w1,m, n) be a homotopy string of length b > 0 such that W is the
concatenation of the following homotopy letters:
(wb,m = mb, nb), (wb−1,mb−1, nb−1), . . . , (w1,m1, n = n1).
96 CHAPTER 4. THE DERIVED CATEGORY OF A GENTLE ALGEBRA
Then, for each i ∈ Z, let
Ii =
{r | mr = i} t {0} if i = n
{r | mr = i} otherwise.
The string complex PW associated to W is the complex with P iW :=
⊕r∈Ii
P (θW (r))
in degree i where θW (r) = t(wr) for r > 0 and θW (0) = s(w1) and zero in all other de-
grees. The differentials are matrices where the entries are determined by the homotopy
letters of W : for each direct wr there is a non-zero entry P (θW (r))w∗r−→ P (θW (r − 1))
and for every inverse wr there is a non-zero entry P (θW (r − 1))w∗r−→ P (θW (r)). The
remaining entries in the matrices are zero.
Example 4.2.2. Consider the algebra given in Example 4.1.1 and consider the ho-
motopy string given in Example 4.1.6 with the following unfolded diagram.
2 1 0 1 2 3
• •eoo •foo c // • b // • af // •A conceptually useful intermediate diagram is the following.
0 1 2 3
• b // • af // ••
c 44
f** • e // •
Then the string complex arising from this homotopy string is the following.
P (0)( c f ) // P (2)⊕ P (3)
( b 00 e )// P (1)⊕ P (4)
(af0
)// P (3)
The non-zero degrees are 0, 1, 2 and 3.
If W is primitive left resolvable then the set Ii is finite for each i ∈ Z and so the
string complex P∞W is defined in exactly the same way. Similarly, we can define PW∞
and P∞W∞ for primitive right and two-sided resolvable strings W respectively.
Example 4.2.3. Consider the algebra given in Example 4.1.1 and consider the left
resolvable string with the following unfolded diagram.
−5 −4 −3 −2 −1 0
. . .e // • d // • f // • e // • dc // • b // •
Then the string complex associated to this infinite string is the following.
. . . e // P (4) d // P (0)f // P (3) e // P (4) dc // P (2) b // P (1)
4.2. INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES 97
Remark 4.2.4. The terminology ‘resolvable’ refers to the fact that such strings are
projective resolutions of certain complexes. For example, the string complex in Ex-
ample 4.2.3 is the projective resolution of the complex
ker(dc) // P (4) dc // P (2) b // P (1)
Let U = (1t,m,m) be a homotopy string of length 0. Then the string complex
PU associated to U is the complex with P (t) in degree m and zeroes elsewhere.
Remark 4.2.5. Let W be an infinite length homotopy string (that does not necessarily
arise from a resolvable string). As long as the set Ii is finite for every i ∈ Z, the above
construction makes sense. We can therefore extend the above definition of a string
complex to incule PW for such homotopy strings W .
4.2.2 Band complexes
Next we describe the construction of band complexes. The construction is similar to
that of a string complex, but as with the analogous modules, we introduce a parameter
so there is a k∗-indexed family of band complexes for every band.
Let W = (wb · . . . ·w1,m,m) be a homotopy band such that W is the concatenation
of the following homotopy letters:
(wb,m = mb, nb), (wb−1,mb−1, nb−1), . . . , (w1,m1,m = n1).
Then, for each j ∈ Z, let Jj = {r | mr = j}. Let k ∈ k∗. The 1-dimensional band
complex BW ,k,1 associated to W and k is the complex with
BjW ,k,1 =
⊕r∈Jj
P (e(wr))
in degree j. If b > 1 then the differential is described in the same way as for a string
complex except that the entry corresponding to w1 is P (e(w1))kw1−→ P (s(w1)) when w1
is direct and P (s(w1))kw−1−→ P (e(w1)) when w1 is inverse. If b = 1 and w1 is direct, then
the only non-zero differential is P (e(w1))kw1+w−2−→ P (s(w1)) in degrees m− 1 and m. If
b = 1 and w1 is inverse, then the only non-zero differential is P (s(w1))kw−1 +w2−→ P (e(w1))
in degrees m and m+ 1.
98 CHAPTER 4. THE DERIVED CATEGORY OF A GENTLE ALGEBRA
Example 4.2.6. Consider the algebra given in Example 4.1.1 and consider the band
(d− · e− · f− · c · b · a, 0, 0) as in Example 4.1.7 with the unfolded diagram.
0 −1 −2 −3 −2 −1 0
. . . a // • •doo •eoo •foo c // • b // • a // . . .
As with the string complex, the following diagram is useful in understanding the
construction of the band complex.
−3 −2 −1 0
• b // • a++•
c 33
f ++•
• e// • d
33
Let k ∈ k∗, then the band complex defined by this band is the following.
P (0)( c f ) // P (2)⊕ P (3)
( b 00 e )// P (1)⊕ P (4)
( kad )// P (0)
Let Dj : BjW ,k,1 → Bj+1
W ,k,1 be the jth differential map in BW ,k,1 for each j ∈ Z and
let r > 1. Then the r-dimensional band complex associated to W and k ∈ k∗ is
the complex with the direct sum (BjW ,k,1)(r) of r copies of Bj
W ,k,1 in degree j. The jth
differential map is given by the matrix
DW ,k,r =
Dj Aj 0 . . . 0
0 Dj Aj . . . 0...
.... . . . . .
...
0 . . . Dj Aj
0 0 . . . 0 Dj
where, if we write djm,n for the (m,n)th entry of Dj, then we define the (m,n)th entry
of Aj to be
ajm,n =
w1 if djm,n = kw1
w−1 if djm,n = kw−1
0 otherwise.
for b > 1. If b = 1, then
ajm,n =
w1 if djm,n = kw1 + w−2
w−1 if djm,n = kw−1 + w2
0 otherwise.
Note that all matrices here are transposed (see Remark 4.1.3).
4.2. INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES 99
Example 4.2.7. Let everything be as in Example 4.2.6. Then the 3-dimensional band
complex is the following.
P (0)3 d1 // (P (2)⊕ P (3))3 d2 // (P (1)⊕ P (4))3 d3 // P (0)3
where d1 and d1 are the block matrices with ( c f ) and ( b 00 e ) respectively on the diagonal
and
d3 =
ka a 0
d 0 0
0 ka a
0 d 0
0 0 ka
0 0 d
To each r-dimensional band complex we associate the following unfolded diagram
to BW ,k,r:
Layer r: · · · kw1 //w1
$$
• wb •wb−1 · · · w2 • kw1 //
w1
##
• wb · · ·
Layer r − 1: · · · kw1 // • wb •wb−1 · · · w2 • kw1 // • wb · · ·
......
Layer 2: · · · kw1 //w1
$$
• wb •wb−1 · · · w2 • kw1 //
w1
##
• wb · · ·
Layer 1: · · · kw1 // • wb •wb−1 · · · w2 • kw1 // • wa · · ·
We refer to the arrows labelled v1 that go between layers as link arrows.
Example 4.2.8. The unfolded diagram for the complex given in Example 4.2.7 is the
following.
Layer 3: · · · ka //a
$$
• •doo •e
oo •foo c // • b // • ka //
a
$$
· · ·
Layer 2: · · · ka //a
$$
• •doo •e
oo •foo c // • b // • ka //
a
$$
· · ·
Layer 1: · · · ka // • •doo •e
oo •foo c // • b // • ka // · · ·
Chapter 5
Morphisms between
indecomposable objects in the
bounded derived category of a
gentle algebra
In this chapter we describe a basis for the k-vectorspace HomKb,−(M,N) where M and
N are indecomposable objects in Kb,− (note that we are using the same abbreviations
as in Remark 4.0.3). These results are analogous to those described in Section 2.4,
originally found in [18, 29, 19]. The work contained in this chapter is joint work with
D. Pauksztello and K. Arnesen and can be found in [1].
5.1 Morphisms between string complexes and 1-
dimensional band complexes
We begin by considering HomKb,−(M,N) when M and N are string complexes or 1-
dimensional band complexes. The basis we obtain for such complexes contains three
families of morphisms: graph maps, single maps and double maps. We first establish
a basis in Cb,− and then identify homotopy classes of basis morphisms, as a result we
completely describe a basis for HomKb,−(M,N).
100
5.1. MORPHISMS BETWEEN STRING AND BAND COMPLEXES 101
5.1.1 The setup and some preliminary lemmas
Let V ,W ∈ HSt ∪ HBa ∪ HRes. Let
QW =
PW if W ∈ HSt ∪ HRes
BW ,k,1 if W ∈ HBa
where k ∈ k∗ and define QV in the same way (where, if QW and QV are both band
complexes, then let QW = BW ,k,1 and QV = BV ,l,1 for k, l ∈ k∗).
Let f : QV → QW . For each degree i ∈ Z, the modules QiV and Qi
W are finite
direct sums of projective modules and so the morphism f i : QiV → Qi
W is a matrix
with entries given by linear combinations of paths in the quiver Q. We will refer to a
scalar multiple of a path arising in this way as a component of f .
Example 5.1.1. Consider the following quiver with the relation bd = 0.
1c
��−1 a // 0
b
@@
2d
oo
Let V = (dcb · dcba, 0, 2) and W = (a− · dcb · dcb · dcba, 0, 2) and consider the
following morphism f : PV → PW .
P (0)( 1+hdcb 0 )��
dcb // P (0)1��
dcba // P (−1)1��
P (0)( dcb a )
// P (0)⊕ P (−1)( dcb0 )
// P (0)dcba// P (−1)
where h ∈ k∗. Then hdcb : P (0)→ P (0) in degree zero is a component of f .
If we display the complexes as unfolded diagrams and adjust the components of f
accordingly, then the structure of the morphism becomes clearer.
P (0) dcb //
1+hdcb��
P (0)1��
dcba // P (−1)1��
P (−1) P (0)aoodcb// P (0)
dcb// P (0)
dcba// P (−1)
By considering the components separately, we are able to spot linearly independent
“parts” of f . For example, f decomposes as follows.
102 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
P (0) dcb //
1��
P (0)1��
dcba // P (−1)1��
P (−1) P (0)aoodcb// P (0)
dcb// P (0)
dcba// P (−1)
and
P (0) bcd //
hdcb��
P (0) dcba // P (−1)
P (−1) P (0)aoodcb// P (0)
dcb// P (0)
dcba// P (−1)
where the absence of arrows indicates a zero entry in the corresponding matrix.
The following lemma is really about certain possible configurations of morphisms
between indecomposable projective modules in A-mod but the diagram we consider
is deliberately arranged to resemble a component of a morphism between string and
1-dimensional band complexes since this will be where it is applied.
Suppose we have the following set up:
• vL
fL��
(∗)
•(∗∗)
vR
fC��
•fR��
• wL• wR
•
where the • stand for indecomposable projective modules in A-mod and vL, vR, wL,
wR, fL, fR, fC are paths in Q. The lines • • may indicate a morphism from left
to right or from right to left. If this orientation means that any one of vLvR, wLwR,
vRvL or wRwL is a path in Q then we require that it is contained in I.
Lemma 5.1.2. Suppose the above configuration of morphisms between indecomposable
projective modules in A-mod is such that
1. fC is a path of length > 0;
2. vL is direct if and only if wL is direct;
3. vR is direct if and only if wR is direct; and
4. the squares (∗) and (∗∗) commute.
Then at most one of (∗) and (∗∗) has a non-zero commutativity relation.
5.1. MORPHISMS BETWEEN STRING AND BAND COMPLEXES 103
Proof. Consider the case where all four homotopy letters vL, vR, wL and wR are di-
rect; the arguments for the remaining orientations are completely analogous. Suppose
vLfC = fLwL 6= 0. The paths fC and wL start with the same arrow and since wLwR = 0
it follows that fCwR = 0. Similarly, if fCwR = vRfR 6= 0 then fC and vR start with the
same arrow, but vLvR = 0 and so vLfC = 0.
5.1.2 A basis in Cb,−(A-proj)
The key to understanding the decomposition of morphisms between string and 1-
dimensional band complexes is to “unfold” the morphisms as we did in Example 5.1.1.
We use this method of presentation to define the form of the basic morphisms; we
begin by describing how the unfolded diagrams represent particular morphisms.
Consider the following diagram representing a morphism between the string or 1-
dimensional band complexes QV and QW . The horizontal parts • • represent
sections of the unfolded diagrams of W and V (so, for each 0 ≤ t ≤ p, we have that
vi+t and wj+t are paths in Q and the scalars kt and lt will be equal to 1 unless V and
W are homotopy bands respectively). The arrows f0, . . . , fp+1 represent entries in the
matrices that give the relevant degree of a morphism f : QV → QW :
degrees: tp+1 tp t1 t0
QV : •fp+1 ��
kpvi+p •fp ��
· · · k1vi+1 • k0vi
f1 ��
•f0��
QW : •lpwj+p
• · · ·l1wj+1
•l0wj
•
degrees: tp+1 tp t1 t0
An important point here is that the degrees of the unfolded diagrams must agree
for this to make sense and so the orientation of vi+t and wj+t must agree for each
0 ≤ t ≤ p. Also, the squares in the diagram must commute if it is to correspond to
a well-defined morphism of complexes. See Example 5.1.1 for an illustration of how
such diagrams may be used to construct morphisms QV → QW .
Lemma 5.1.2 allows us to identify linearly independent parts of morphisms from
QV to QW . Next we define three classes of morphism that will turn out to form a
k-linear basis for HomCb,−(QV , QW ).
Definition 5.1.3 (Graph map). Let V and W ∈ HSt ∪ HBa ∪ HRes. A graph map
QV → QW is a morphism whose non-zero components can be displayed in an unfolded
104 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
diagram as follows.
degrees: tp tp−1 t1 t0
QV : •fL ��
kLvL •1=mp+1��
kpup •mp��
kp−1up−1· · · k2u2 •m2 ��
k1u1 •m1 ��
kRvR •fR��
QW : •lLwL
•lpup
•lp−1up−1
· · ·l2u2
•l1u1•
lRwR•
degrees: tp tp−1 t1 t0
where
1. mi ∈ k for each 1 ≤ i ≤ p;
2. wL 6= vL and wR 6= vR;
3. the square
• kiui
mi+1 ��
•mi��
•liui•
commutes for each 1 ≤ i ≤ p;
4. if vL and wL exist and have the same orientation then there exists some scalar
multiple of a path fL such that the square
• kLvL
fL ��
•1��
•lLwL
•
commutes; otherwise we have the following orientation
• •kLvLoo
1��•
lLwL// •
where either of vL and wL may not exist;
5. if vR and wR exist and have same orientation then there exists some scalar
multiple of a path fR such that the square
• kRvR
m1 ��
•fR��
•lRwR
•
commutes; otherwise we have the following orientation
• kRvR //m1 ��
•
• •lRwRoo
where either of vR and wR may not exist.
5.1. MORPHISMS BETWEEN STRING AND BAND COMPLEXES 105
Remark 5.1.4. The dotted lines in the diagram represent arrows that may not exist;
for example, if V is a homotopy string with the first homotopy letter (u1, t1, t0), then vR
is said not to exist. Moreover, if V ,W ∈ HRes then the sequence of commuting squares
may continue infinitely far to the left or right; if the diagram is left (respectively right)
infinite then vL and wL (respectively vR and wR) are said not to exist.
Example 5.1.5. Again consider the quiver with the relations in Example 5.1.1 and
consider homotopy letters V = (dcb ·dcba, 0, 2) and W = (a− ·dcb ·dcb ·dcba, 0, 2). The
unfolded diagram
P (0) dcb //
1��
P (0)1��
dcba // P (−1)1��
P (−1) P (0)aoodcb// P (0)
dcb// P (0)
dcba// P (−1)
defines the following graph map:
P (0)( 1 0 )��
dcb // P (0)1��
dcba // P (−1)1��
P (0)( dcb a )
// P (0)⊕ P (−1)( dcb0 )
// P (0)dcba// P (−1)
Definition 5.1.6 (Single map). Let V and W ∈ HSt ∪ HBa ∪ HRes. A single map
QV → QW is a morphism whose non-zero component f is a string of length 6= 0 and
can be displayed in an unfolded diagram as follows.
• kLvL • kRvR
f��
•
•lLwL
•lRwR
•
where the following conditions hold for f .
1. If we have • kLvL // • , then vLf = 0 and if we have • •lLwLoo , then fwL = 0.
2. If we have • •kRvRoo , then vRf = 0 and if we have • lRwR // • , then fwR = 0.
Example 5.1.7. Consider algebra given in Example 4.1.1 and consider the homotopy
strings V = (f · e, 0, 2) and W = (c− · f · e, 0, 1). Then there exists the following
unfolded diagram.
• f //
f
��
• e // •
• • e//
coo •
f// •
106 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
which gives defines the following single map.
P (0)f //
( 0 f )��
P (3) e // P (4)
P (0)( c f )
// P (3)⊕ P (2) e// P (4)
Definition 5.1.8 (Double map). Let V and W ∈ HSt∪HBa∪HRes. A double map
QV → QW is a morphism whose non-zero components fL and fR are strings of length
6= 0 and can be displayed in an unfolded diagram as follows.
• kLvL • kCvC //fL ��
• kRvR
fR��
•
•lLwL
•lCwC
// •lRwR
•
where
1. the central square has a non-zero commutativity relation i.e. vCfC = fLwC 6= 0;
2. fL satisfies the first condition in the definition of a single map; and
3. fR satisfies the second condition in the definition of a single map.
We will sometimes use the notation (fL, fR) for such a double map.
Example 5.1.9. Consider the algebra given in Example 4.1.1. Then we have the
following unfolded diagram
• dc // • b // • a //
a
��
•f��
• •coo
f// • e // •
which gives rise to the following double map.
P (4) dc // P (2) b // P (1) a //
a
��
P (0)
( 0 f )
��P (0)
( c f )// P (2)⊕ P (3) e // P (1)
Observation 5.1.10. It follows directly from the requirement that the squares in
the unfolded diagrams commute that single, double or graph maps are completely
determined by any non-zero component.
5.1. MORPHISMS BETWEEN STRING AND BAND COMPLEXES 107
Let V ,W ∈ HSt t HBa t HRes. Let BCV ,W be the set of graph, single and double
maps in HomCb,−(QV , QW ).
Proposition 5.1.11. Let V ,W ∈ HSt t HBa t HRes. Then BCV ,W is a k-linear basis
for HomCb,−(QV , QW ).
Proof. First we show that BCV ,W is a linearly independent set. Let f be a non-zero
element of BCV ,W . Suppose f =
m∑i=1
kifm is some linear combination of elements of BCV ,W
with fi 6= fj for all 1 ≤ i, j ≤ m. Then, by Observation 5.1.10, and the fact that all
relations in a gentle algebra are monomial, it follows that f = fi and ki = 1 for some
1 ≤ i ≤ m and by the same reasoning kj = 0 for all j 6= i.
Next we show that BCV ,W spans HomCb,−(QV , QW ). Let h : QV → QW be a non-zero
morphism and let h′ : P (i)→ P (j) be a non-zero component of h (the term component
is defined at the beginning of Section 5.1.1). Consider the unfolded diagram with this
non-zero component. Since ever projective in QV has at most two non-zero components
of the differential incident with it. It follows that the unfolded diagrams with this non-
zero component determine a scalar multiple of an element of BCV ,W that by Lemma 5.1.2
must be a summand of h and by Observation 5.1.10 is uniquely determined.
5.1.3 A basis in Kb,−(A-proj)
In this section we will consider morphisms QV → QW up to homotopy equivalence.
Let f, g ∈ HomCb,−(QV , QW ), then f and g are homotopy equivalent if there exists
a morphism hi : QiV → Qi−1
W for each i ∈ Z such that f i− gi = diQVhi+1 +hidi−1
QW(where
composition is carried out from left to right as before). Such a family {hi}i∈Z is known
as a homotopy from f to g. In this case we will write f ' g and if g = 0 then we
say that f is null-homotopic.
Let f ∈ BCV ,W and let
H(f) := {g ∈ BCV ,W | f ' kg, k ∈ k}.
This is not the same as the homotopy equivalence class of f but if h : QV → QW
is such that h ' f then h decomposes into a linear combination of elements from
H(f)∪H(0). Thus the set BKV ,W := {H(f) | f ∈ BC
V ,W } is a basis for HomKb,−(QV , QW ).
As we did with morphisms in the previous section, we will consider components of
108 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
the homotopy {hi}i∈Z. That is, if f and g are components of homotopy equivalent
morphisms corresponding to the following unfolded diagram:
• kivi •ki+1vi+1
f−g��
•
•ljwj•lj+1wj+1
•
Then there must be components of the homotopy that compose with the paths vi,
vi+1, wj, wj+1 to make up f − g. Of course, this will depend on the orientation of the
diagram. For example, if we have the following orientation:
• kivi // •h1
��
ki+1vi+1//
�� h3��
•h2
��•
ljwj// • •lj+1wj+1
oo
then h1, h2, h3 are components (i.e. scalar multiples of paths) of the homotopy and
f − g = lj(h1 + h2)wj + ki+1vi+1h3.
We begin by showing that graph maps are not null-homotopic and have trivial
homotopy classes.
Proposition 5.1.12. Let f : QV → QW be a graph map. Then H(f) = {f}.
Proof. Let g ∈ H(f) and suppose f is labelled as in Definition 5.1.3. Then consider
the entry gi in the matrix gtp that fits into the unfolded diagram as follows:
tp tp−1
QV : •fL ��
kLvL •gi �� 1��
kpup •mp��
kp−1up−1
QW : •lLwL
•lpup
•lp−1up−1
tp tp−1
We will assume that the diagram is oriented with • kpup // • ; the argument for the
other orientation is similar. Then there are components of the homotopy h1, h2, h3
such that 1 − gi = kpuph1 + kLvLh2 + lLh3wL (where we take h2 = 0 if we have
• kLvL // • and h3 = 0 if we have • •lLwLoo ). The compositions uph1, vLh2 and h3wL
must consist of paths of length > 0 since the differential only contains paths of length
> 0, but no linear combination of such paths can yield a 1. Therefore we must have
that kpuph1 + kLvLh2 + lLh3wL = 0 and gi = 1. By Observation 5.1.10 it follows that
f = g.
5.1. MORPHISMS BETWEEN STRING AND BAND COMPLEXES 109
Suppose f, g ∈ BCV ,W are not graph maps. We say that there is a graph homotopy
between f and g if the unfolded diagram of QV and Σ−1QW are related as follows.
degrees: tp tp−1 t1 t0
QV : • kLvL •mp+1��
kpup •mp��
kp−1up−1· · · k2u2 •m2 ��
k1u1 •m1 ��
kRvR •
Σ−1QW : •lLwL
•lpup
•lp−1up−1
· · ·l2u2
•l1u1•
lRwR•
degrees: tp tp−1 t1 t0
Where mp+1 = 1 and mi ∈ k such that kimi = −mi+1li for 1 ≤ i ≤ p and the following
conditions must be satisfied.
1. If f is a single map then either we have • kLvL // • and f = vL; or we have
• •lLwLoo and f = wL.
2. If f = (fL, fR) is a double map then we have • kLvL // • and fL = vL and we have
• •lLwLoo and fR = wL.
3. If g is a single map then either we have • lRwR // • and g = wR; or we have
• •kRvRoo and g = vR.
4. If f = (fL, fR) is a double map then we have • kLvL // • and fL = vL and we have
• •lLwLoo and fR = wL.
We will sometimes write h : QV Σ−1QW to denote such a graph homotopy.
Example 5.1.13. This example demonstrates how an unfolded diagram such as the
one above describes a homotopy {hi}i∈Z between f and g.
Consider the algebra as in Example 4.1.1 and consider the following single map.
P (0)f //
( 0 c )
��
P (3) e // P (4) dc // P (2)
P (0)( f c ) // P (3)⊕ P (2)
( e0 )// P (4) dc // P (2) b // P (1)
We will refer to this single map as c. Consider the following graph homotopy from
c.
0 1 2 3
• f //
1��
•−1��
e // •1��
dc // •−1��
• • f //coo • e // • dc // • b // •1 0 1 2 3 4
110 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
We will show how this can be used to construct a family of basis morphisms that
are homotopy equivalent to c. First note that we have the following list of graph
homotopies starting at c that are contained in the above maximal graph homotopy.
• f //
1��
• e // • dc // •
• • f //coo • e // • dc // • b // •
• f //
1��
•−1��
e // • dc // •
• • f //coo • e // • dc // • b // •
• f //
1��
•−1��
e // •1��
dc // •
• • f //coo • e // • dc // • b // •These graph homotopies give rise to the following homotopies.
P (0)f //
( f c )
��
1
xx
P (3) e // P (4) dc // P (2)
P (0)( f c )
// P (3)⊕ P (2)( e0 )
// P (4)dc// P (2)
b// P (1)
P (0)f //
( 0 c )
��1xx
P (3)
(−1 0 )xx−e��
e // P (4) dc // P (2)
P (0)( f c )
// P (3)⊕ P (2)( e0 )
// P (4)dc// P (2)
b// P (1)
P (0)f //
( 0 c )
��1xx
P (3)
(−1 0 )
xx
e // P (4)
1{{dc��
dc // P (2)
P (0)( f c )
// P (3)⊕ P (2)( e0 )
// P (4)dc// P (2)
b// P (1)
And finally the maximal graph homotopy gives rise to the following homotopy.
P (0)f //
( 0 c )��1xx
P (3)
(−1 0 )
xx
e // P (4)
1{{
dc // P (2)
−1{{−b��
P (0)( f c )
// P (3)⊕ P (2)( e0 )
// P (4)dc// P (2)
b// P (1)
So c ' −f ' e ' −dc ' b.
Lemma 5.1.14. If there is a homotopy starting at f ∈ BCV ,W containing a component
given by a path of length > 0, then f is null-homotopic.
5.1. MORPHISMS BETWEEN STRING AND BAND COMPLEXES 111
Proof. By Propositon 5.1.12, we may assume that f is a single or a double map; we
will only give the argument for a single map since the argument for a double map is
similar.
Without loss of generality, suppose the component given by a path of length > 0
is adjacent to a non-zero component f of f since otherwise there will be a homotopy
consisting of identities between f and some other single or double map with this
property. Suppose we have the following orientation of wj and there is component h
of a homotopy such that h is a path of length > 0.
• kivi •h
��
ki+1vi+1
f��
•
lj−1wj−1•
ljwj// •lj+1wj+1
•
This defines a null-homotopy because all other entries can be taken to be zero and, if
we have, • kivi // • (respectively • •ki+1vi+1oo ), then vih = 0 (respectively vi+1h) because
vif = 0 and vi+1f = 0 by definition of a single map. Moreover, if we have • •lj−1wj−1oo ,
then hwj−1 = 0 since hwj 6= 0 and the algebra is gentle. All other orientations will
yield a similar result.
Proposition 5.1.15. Let f, g ∈ BCV ,W be distinct morphisms and suppose neither f ' 0
nor g ' 0. Then f ' g if and only if there is a graph homotopy between g and f .
Proof. Clearly if there is a graph homotopy between f and g then it can be used to
construct a homotopy {hi}i∈Z giving us that f ' g.
So suppose that f ' g. Since g and f are distinct, it follows from Proposition
5.1.12 that they are not graph maps. We will consider the case where f and g are
single maps; the case where either (or both) of them is a double map is similar.
First we suppose that the non-zero component of f and g (which we will denote by
f and g respectively from now on) are in the same position on the unfolded diagram.
By Observation 5.1.10, we have f 6= g . We are in the following situation.
• kLvL • kRvR
f ��g��
•
•lLwL
•lRwR
•
As we have noted before Proposition 5.1.12, there must be some non-zero components
of the homotopy that compose with vL, vR,wL or wR to give f − g . By Lemma 5.1.14,
112 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
if any of these component of the homotopy is a path of length > 0, then it implies
that f ' g ' 0. So all components must be given by scalar multiplication. Without
loss of generality, suppose g is equal to either vR or wR and f is equal to either vL or
wL (otherwise invert one of the homotopy strings and relabel).
We consider the case where we have • kRvR // • , g = vR and there is a component
of the homotopy given by a scalar multiple m ∈ k.
• kLvL • kRvR
f ��g��
•myy•
lLwL•lRwR
•
If we consider some non-zero components the homotopy is forced to have under this
assumption, it follows that we have the following unfolded diagram (where u and w
have the indicated orientation if they exist) with m1, . . . ,mp ∈ k.
QV : • kRvR •m��
kpup •mp��
kp−1up−1· · · k2u2 •m2 ��
k1u1 •m1 ��
kv // •
Σ−1QW : • •lpup•lp−1up−1
· · ·l2u2
•l1u1• •
lwoo
If we construct a homotopy from this diagram (as we did in Example 5.1.13) then
we produce a null-homotopy from g and so f ' g ' 0, contradicting our initial
assumption. In the case where • •lRwRoo , g = wR a similar null-homotopy is produced.
We may therefore assume that f and g are in different positions in the unfolded
diagrams of QV and QW . Without loss of generality we again assume that the non-zero
component of the homotopy incident with g is m as above. If we again consider the
non-zero components the homotopy is forced to have to the right of g , then it is clear
that we must produce a graph homotopy from g to f . In particular, the components
of the homotopy induced by m must either satisfy the condition (5) in the definition
of a graph map QV → Σ−1QW , in which case they will define a null-homotopy, a
contradiction, or f will satisfy condition (3) in the definition of a graph homotopy
from g to f .
Definition 5.1.16 (Maximal graph homotopy). Consider a graph homotopy {hi}i∈Zfrom f to g such that vL 6= wL and vR 6= wR. The associated unfolded diagram
shall be referred to as a maximal graph homotopy. The graph homotopy that
corresponds to the identity when QV∼= ΣQW is a band complex is also a maximal
graph homotopy.
5.1. MORPHISMS BETWEEN STRING AND BAND COMPLEXES 113
Remark 5.1.17. In [1], we use the term quasi-graph map rather than maximal graph
homotopy. This terminology is explained by the fact that a maximal graph homotopy
can be thought of as analogous to a graph map QV → Σ−1QW except conditions (4)
and (5) of the definition must not be satisfied.
Remark 5.1.18. Consider a maximal graph homotopy and suppose it is labelled as
in the definition of a graph homotopy. As we saw in Example 5.1.13, this defines
a homotopy from a morphism f that is either a single map with component vL or
wL or a double map (vL,wL). The homotopy is from f to a single or double map g
with component(s) corresponding to vR and/or wR. There is also a family of graph
homotopies from single maps with component ui to single maps with component uj
(where 1 ≤ i < j ≤ p) given by “sub-diagrams” of the maximal graph homotopy.
Thus H(f) = {f, g, u1, . . . , up} (where we identify the components ui with the single
maps themselves).
It follows that the classes H(f) 6= H(0) with more than one element correspond to
maximal graph homotopies between single and double maps.
Corollary 5.1.19. The classes H(f) where f ∈ BCV ,W is not null-homotopic and
H(f) 6= {f} are in one-to-one correspondence with maximal graph homotopies.
Finally we must consider single and double maps that are not null-homotopic and
are not homotopy equivalent to any other elements of BCV ,W . That is, the single and
double maps that arise in such a way that they cannot be part of a graph homotopy.
A simple application of the definitions gives rise to the following list.
Corollary 5.1.20. 1. A non-null-homotopic single map f ∈ BCV ,W is such that
H(f) = {f} if and only if the corresponding unfolded diagram is one of the
following (up to inverting one of the homotopy strings).
(a)
• kLvL •f��•lRwR
•
(b)
• kLvL •kRffR //
f��
•
•lRwR
•
114 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
(c)
• kLvL •f��
•lLfLf
// •lRwR
•
(d)
• kLvL •kRffR //
f��
•
•lLfLf
// •lRwR
•
where fR and fL are paths of length > 0 and none of vL, vR,wL or wR are equal
to f .
2. A double map f = (fL, fR) ∈ BCV ,W with unfolded diagram
• kLvL • kCvC //fL ��
• kRvR
fR��
•
•lLwL
•lCwC
// •lRwR
•
is not null-homotopic and H(f) = {f} if and only if there exists a path f of
length > 0 such that vC = fLf and wC = ffR.
We have now established a basis for HomKb,−(QV , QW ).
Theorem 5.1.21. Let V ,W ∈ HSt t HBa t HRes. Then there is a k-linear basis for
HomKb,−(QV , QW ) consisting of
1. all graph maps QV → QW ;
2. a representative f for each H(f) arising from a maximal graph homotopy; and
3. all single and double maps of the form described in Corollary 5.1.20.
Example 5.1.22. This example demonstrates the Theorem allows us to easily identify
a basis for HomKb,−(QV , QW ) given any two strings or bands V and W .
Consider the quiver with relations given in Example 5.1.1 and consider the two
homotopy strings given in the same example. Let A be the path algebra associated to
the bound quiver, then we can identify the following basis in Cb,−(A-proj).
P (0) dcb //
1��
P (0)1��
dcba // P (−1)1��
P (−1) P (0)aoodcb// P (0)
dcb// P (0)
dcba// P (−1)
5.2. MORPHISMS BETWEEN R-DIMENSIONAL BAND COMPLEXES 115
P (0) bcd //
dcb��
P (0) dcba // P (−1)
P (−1) P (0)aoodcb// P (0)
dcb// P (0)
dcba// P (−1)
P (0) bcd // P (0)dcb��
dcba // P (−1)
P (−1) P (0)aoodcb// P (0)
dcb// P (0)
dcba// P (−1)
P (0)a��
bcd // P (0) dcba // P (−1)
P (−1) P (0)aoodcb
// P (0)dcb
// P (0)dcba// P (−1)
P (0)dcba��
bcd // P (0) dcba // P (−1)
P (−1) P (0)aoodcb
// P (0)dcb
// P (0)dcba// P (−1)
We also have the following maximal graph homotopy and null-homotopy.
P (0) dcb //
1xx dcb��a
ss
P (0)
1xx dcb��
dcba // P (−1)
P (−1) P (0)aoodcb// P (0)
dcb// P (0)
dcba// P (−1)
P (0)dcba ��
bcd // P (0)aww
dcba // P (−1)
P (−1) P (0)aoodcb
// P (0)dcb
// P (0)dcba// P (−1)
So dim HomKb,−(PV , PW ) = 2.
5.2 Morphisms between r-dimensional band com-
plexes
Let V ,W ∈ HBa, k, l ∈ k and r, s ∈ N. In this section we consider morphisms
BV ,k,r → BW ,l,s. We will employ the same strategy as in the previous section; that
is we will establish a basis in Cb,− and then consider homotopy equivalence classes of
basis elements.
116 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
5.2.1 A basis in Cb,−(A-proj)
As with morphisms between strings and 1-dimensional band complexes we will consider
the structure of morphisms in terms of unfolded diagrams. Let f ∈ BCV ,W and suppose
f is not the identity. Then for 1 ≤ m ≤ r and 1 ≤ n ≤ s, we have that f uniquely
determines a morphism f (m,n) : BV ,k,r → BW ,l,s in Cb,− obtained by placing a copy of f
from the indecomposable projective modules in layer m of BV ,k,r to the indecomposable
projective modules in layer n of BW ,l,s. As in Section 5.1.2, the squares in the unfolded
diagrams must commute and so, if some component of the copy of f has a non-zero
composition with a link arrow, then f (m,n) will acquire additional components in order
to satisfy the necessary commutativity relations. As we have assumed that f is not
the identity, the additional components of f (m,n) will at most occur between layers
m+ 1 and n and between layers m and n− 1. We call f (m,n) the lift of f to layers
(m,n).
Example 5.2.1. This example demonstrates what happens when you lift a graph
map that has a component that composes non-trivially with a link arrow. Consider
the gentle algebra given by the quiver
1 a // 2
0 d //
b
OO
3
c
OO
e // 4
6
h
OO
f// 5
g
OO
with relations ab = cd = gf = 0. Consider the bands V = (e · c− · a · bh · f− · g−, 0, 0)
and W = (d− · c− · a · b, 1, 1). Then there is the following graph map BW ,l,1 → BV ,k,1.
. . . •doo
1��
•coo
1��
a // • lb //
1��
•1lh
��
. . .doo
. . . e// • •coo
a// •
bh// • . . .
foo
When we lift this morphism to layers (2, 2) of BW ,l,3 and BV ,k,3, we are forced to add
5.2. MORPHISMS BETWEEN R-DIMENSIONAL BAND COMPLEXES 117
components to ensure that the correct commutativity relations hold in the complex.
. . . •
1l
��
doo •
1l
��
coo a // •
1l
��
lb //b
%%
• . . .doo
. . . •
1
��
doo •
1
��
coo a // •
1
��
lb //b
%%
•
1lh
��
. . .doo
. . . •doo •coo a // • lb // • . . .doo
. . . e// • •coo
a// •
bh// • . . .
foo
. . . e// • •coo
a// •
bh// • . . .
foo
. . . e// • •coo
a// •
bh// • . . .
foo
The lift id(m,n)BV ,k,1
: BV ,k,r → BV ,k,s of the identity idBV ,k,r ∈ BCV ,V to layers (m,n)
behaves slightly differently. The additional components required will occur from layer
m − i to layer n − i for 0 ≤ i ≤ n − 1 and also from layer m + j to layer n + j for
0 ≤ j ≤ r−m; that is, the top-most layers of BV ,k,r will be embedded in the bottom-
most layers of BV ,k,s. It follows that there are exactly min{r, s} lifts of idBV ,k,r ∈ BCV ,V
to morphisms BV ,k,r → BV ,k,s.
Example 5.2.2. This example demonstrates what happens to a lift of the identity
morphism. Consider the algebra given in Example 5.2.1 and the band W = (d− · c− ·
a · b, 0, 0). The following diagram depicts the lift of the identity morphism idBW ,l,1 to
the layers (2, 2) of BW ,l,3 and BW ,l,4.
. . . •
��
doo •
��
coo a // •
��
lb //b
((
•
��
. . .doo
. . . •
��
doo •
��
coo a // •
��
lb //b
((
•
��
. . .doo
. . . •
��
doo •
��
coo a // •
��
lb // •
��
. . .doo
. . . •doo •coo a // • lb //b
((
• . . .doo
. . . •doo •coo a // • lb //b
((
• . . .doo
. . . •doo •coo a // • lb //b
((
• . . .doo
. . . •doo •coo a // • lb // • . . .doo
where all of the components of the lifted morphism are identities.
Lemma 5.2.3. Let BCV ,W (r, s) be the set of possible lifts of elements of BC
V ,W to mor-
phisms BV ,k,r → BW ,l,s. Then BCV ,W (r, s) is a basis for HomCb,−(BV ,k,r, BW ,l,s). In
particular, if d = dim HomCb,−(BV ,k,1, BW ,l,1), then dim HomCb,−(BV ,k,r, BW ,l,s) is as
follows.
118 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
1. If BV ,k,1 is isomorphic to BW ,l,1, then
dim HomCb,−(BV ,k,r, BW ,l,s) = rs(d− 1) + min{r, s}.
2. If BV ,k,1 and BW ,l,1 are not isomorphic, then we have
dim HomCb,−(BV ,k,r, BW ,l,s) = rs(d).
Proof. Consider some component of a morphism f : BV ,k,r → BW ,l,s. The requirement
that the squares commute in the unfolded diagrams and Lemma 5.1.2 will ensure
that this component is a scalar multiple of an element of BCV ,W (r, s) and that this
morphism is a summand of f . Repeating this reasoning will yield that BCV ,W (r, s)
spans HomCb,−(BV ,k,r, BW ,l,s).
By construction, an element of BCV ,W (r, s) that has been lifted to layers (m,n) is
completely determined by any non-zero component between layers m and n. Then, by
the same argument as in the first half of the proof of Proposition 5.1.11, the elements
of BCV ,W (r, s) are linearly independent.
5.2.2 A basis in Kb,−(A-proj)
As in the previous section, we now consider the homotopy equivalence classes of the
elements f of the basis BCV ,W (r, s). We can define the lift of a graph homotopy
to layers (m,n) in the same way as the lift of a morphism. The same reasoning
as the previous section mean that any homotopy from f to some other morphism
g must decompose into a linear combination of lifts of graph homotopies (and null-
homotopies). Therefore, we can completely determine the homotopy equivalence class
of f by describing the morphisms that are homotopy equivalent to f via a lift of a
graph homotopy. The following lemma is immediate from these observations.
Lemma 5.2.4. Let BV ,k,r and BW ,l,s be band complexes and let f ∈ BCV ,W . If we have
H(f) = {f}, then for every pair (m,n) with 1 ≤ m ≤ r and 1 ≤ n ≤ s the lifted
morphism f (m,n) is not homotopy equivalent to any other lifted basis morphism.
Again, the subtlety arises when the components of the graph homotopies compose
with link arrows. It is clear that if a lifted graph homotopy does not compose with a
link map then we can construct a homotopy between lifted single or double maps as
we did in the previous section.
5.2. MORPHISMS BETWEEN R-DIMENSIONAL BAND COMPLEXES 119
Lemma 5.2.5. Let BV ,k,r and BW ,l,s be band complexes. If a lift h(m,n) of a maximal
graph homotopy h : BV ,k,1 Σ−1BW ,l,1 does not have any component that composes
with a link arrow and if H(f) is the set of homotopy equivalent basis morphisms cor-
responding to h (see Section 5.1.3), then the lift of h to layers (m,n) defines a family
of homotopies between lifts g(m,n)1 and g
(m,n)2 where g1, g2 ∈ H(f).
Proof. This is clear by the same reasoning as in the previous section. See Example
5.1.13.
It remains to consider graph homotopies where there is some non-zero component
that composes with a link arrow. We will begin by considering the case where BV ,k,1
is not isomorphic to Σ−1BW ,l,1 (see Example 5.2.11 for a demonstration of why this is
a special case).
Example 5.2.6. This example demonstrates what happens when a component of a
graph homotopy composes with a link arrow. Consider the algebra given in Example
5.2.1 and consider the bands V = (a ·bh ·f− ·g− ·e ·c−, 0, 0) and W = (d− ·c− ·a ·b, 1, 1).
The following diagram shows a double map and a single map BV ,k,1 → BW ,l,1.
1 0 1 0 1 2 1
. . . •goo e //e��
•d
rr
•kcoo a // • hb //
b��
• . . .foo
. . . •d
oo •coo
a// •
lb// • •
doo . . .c
oo
1 0 −1 0 1 0 −1
The following diagram shows a maximal graph homotopy that exists between the
double map (e, d) and the single map b.
1 0 1 0 1 2 1
. . . •goo e // •1��
•−k��
kcoo a // •k��
hb // • . . .foo
. . .lb
// • •d
oo •coo
a// •
lb// • . . .
doo
1 2 1 0 1 2 1
If we lift these morphisms and the graph homotopy to the layers (2, 2) in the complexes
BV ,k,3 and BW ,l,3, the we see that we obtain a homotopy from the double map (e, d)
to a linear sum of a pair of lifts of the single map b as well as a lift of the single map c.
This is displayed on the diagram below; the graph homotopy is shown as solid arrows
and the morphisms are shown as dashed arrows.
120 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
. . . •goo e // • •
c
{{
kcooc
vv
a // • hb // • . . .foo
. . . •
e
��
goo e // •
d
��
1
��
•
−k
��
kcooc
vv
a // •
klb
��
kb
��
k
��
hb // • . . .foo
. . . •gooe
// • •kcoo a // • hb // • . . .foo
. . . •d
oo •coo
a// •
lb//
b ((
• •d
oo . . .coo
. . . •d
oo •coo
a// •
lb//
b ((
• •d
oo . . .coo
. . . •d
oo •coo
a// •
lb// • •
doo . . .c
oo
So (e, d)(2,2) ' −(klb(2,2) + c(3,2) + kb(2,1)).
We will choose a homotopy equivalence class representative of the additional sum-
mands we acquire. The following example shows how we can always write a lifted
single map as a linear combination of single maps corresponding to the right-most link
arrow.
Example 5.2.7. Consider the homotopy given in Example 5.2.6. There exists the
following lifted graph homotopy between c(3,2) and lb(3,2) + b(3,1).
. . . •goo e // • •
c
{{
1
��
kcooc
vv
a // •
−1
��
−lb
��
−b
��
hb // • . . .foo
. . . •goo e // • •kcooc
vv
a // • hb // • . . .foo
. . . •gooe
// • •kcoo a // • hb // • . . .foo
. . . •d
oo •coo
a// •
lb//
b ((
• •d
oo . . .coo
. . . •d
oo •coo
a// •
lb//
b ((
• •d
oo . . .coo
. . . •d
oo •coo
a// •
lb// • •
doo . . .c
oo
If we consider the homotopy given by the sum of this lifted graph homotopy and the one
given in Example 5.2.6, then we have that (e, d)(2,2) ' −(klb(2,2)+lb(3,2)+b(3,1)+kb(2,1)).
Lemma 5.2.8. Let BV ,k,r and BW ,l,s be band complexes such that BV ,k,1 is not isomor-
phic to Σ−1BW ,l,1. Suppose we have a maximal graph homotopy h : BV ,k,1 ΣBW ,l,1
from f to g for f, g ∈ BCV ,W such that some lift of h has a component that composes
with a link morphism. Then any lift g(m,n) : BV ,k,r → BW ,l,s of g ∈ H(f) is homotopy
equivalent to a linear combination of lifts of the right-most link arrow that composes
with a component of h.
5.2. MORPHISMS BETWEEN R-DIMENSIONAL BAND COMPLEXES 121
Remark 5.2.9. To clarify what we mean in the statement of the lemma, consider the
case where h is as follows.
• vL •1��
ut · · · •±1 ��
kup// •±k ��
up−1· · ·uq+1 • uq //
±k��
•±kl��
· · · •±kl ��
vR•
• vL• ut · · · • up
// • up−1· · ·uq+1
•luq// • · · · • vR
•
Then, for any g ∈ H(f) and 1 ≤ m ≤ r, 1 ≤ n ≤ s, we have g(m,n) is homotopy
equivalent to a linear combination of lifts of uq.
Proof. Without loss of generality we will assume that the maximal graph homotopy
we are considering is given by the diagram above. Note that this fixes the orientation
of uq and up, as well as the fact that the link arrow in BV ,k,r is to the left of the link
arrow in BW ,l,s. The proof requires only minor modifications for the other cases.
Then H(f) = {f, g, u1, · · · , up, · · · , uq, · · · , ut} where we have identified the single
maps arising from h with their non-zero component (see Remark 5.1.18). We will
consider lifts of elements of H(f) to (m,n).
First consider the ui such that 1 ≤ i ≤ q. Then there is a graph homotopy that
can be lifted to layers (m,n) such that u(m,n)q ' ±u(m,n)
i (just take a scalar multiple of
the section of the above homotopy between ui and uq). Similarly, u(m,n) ' g(m,n).
Next suppose q < i < p. Then there is a lift of a graph homotopy giving us that
u(m,n)i ' ±(lu(m,n)
q +u(m,n−1)q ) (again, take the lift of the section of the above homotopy
between ui and uq).
Finally consider g or ui such that p ≤ i ≤ t. We argue for ui, the argument for g
is the same. Then there is a lifted graph homotopy giving ui ' ±(lu(m,n)q + u(m,n−1)
q +
u(m+1,n)p ) (this is given by lifting the section of the above graph homotopy between
ui and uq). But then if we lift the same section of the above homotopy to the layers
(m+ 1, n) we have that ui ' ±(lu(m,n)q + u(m,n−1)
q ± (lu(m+1,n)q + u(m+1,n−1)
q + u(m+2,n)p )).
We can then lift the same section of the homotopy to layers (m + 2, n) and so on.
Finally note that the section of the homotopy lifted to layers (r, n) does not acquire
any additional up term and so we are done.
Lemma 5.2.10. Let h, BV ,k,r and BW ,l,s be as in Lemma 5.2.8. Then the lifts u(m,n)q
for 1 ≤ m ≤ r, 1 ≤ n ≤ s are linearly independent in HomKb,−(BV ,k,r, BW ,l,s).
Proof. Suppose∑i,j
ki,ju(i,j)q ' 0 where i and j range over 1 ≤ i ≤ r, 1 ≤ j ≤ s. We have
already observed that this null-homotopy must decompose into a linear combination of
122 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
lifts of graph homotopies. The only possible such null-homotopy is a linear combination
of lifts of a graph homotopy without end points (i.e. one lifted from the identity
BV ,k,1 Σ−1BW ,l,1). But we have assumed that BV ,k,1 is not isomorphic to Σ−1BW ,l,1
and so we must have∑i,j
ki,ju(i,j)q = 0. By Lemma 5.2.3, it follows that ki,j = 0 for all
1 ≤ i ≤ r, 1 ≤ j ≤ s.
Next we consider the special homotopy arising when BV ,k,1∼= Σ−1BW ,l,1.
Example 5.2.11. Consider the algebra given in Example 5.2.1 and consider the band
V = (a · bh · f− · g− · e · c−, 0, 0). This example demonstrates what happens when
we lift the graph homotopy that is supported on the whole band. Below we show the
lifted maps kc(3,1) : BV ,k,3 → ΣBV ,k,3 and kc(2,1) and the homotopy between them. This
homotopy is obtained by lifting the ‘identity’ graph homotopy to the layers (2, 2).
. . . •goo e // • •
−c
{{
kcooc
vv
a // • hb // • . . .foo
. . . •
1
��
goo e // •
−1
��
•
1
��
c
{{
kcooc
vv
a // •
−1
��
hb // •
1
��
. . .
−1
��
foo
. . . •gooe
// • •kcoo a // • hb // • . . .foo
. . .e // • •kcoo
c
vv
a // • hb // • •foo . . .goo
. . . e // • •kcooc
vv
a // • hb // • •foo . . .goo
. . . e// • •kcoo a // • hb // • •foo . . .
goo
Consider the following graph homotopy h : BV ,k,1 BV ,k,1.
· · ·kv1 •±1 ��
vb •∓1 ��
vb−1· · · • vq
∓1��
•±1��
· · · v2 • kv1
∓1��
•±1��
vb · · ·
· · ·kv1• vb• vb−1· · · • vq
• · · · v2•kv1• vb· · ·
For each 1 ≤ t ≤ b, let vt : BV ,k,1 → ΣBV ,k,1 denote associated single maps in H(v1).
It follows from Lemma 5.2.8 that all lifts v (m,n)t for 1 ≤ t ≤ b can be written as
a linear combination of lifts v (i,j)q of vq. It remains to determine how many linearly
independent non-null homotopy classes are lifted from H(vq). For this we will require
the following lemma.
Lemma 5.2.12. Consider the homotopy h given above. For 1 ≤ i < r and 1 < j ≤ s,
we have v (i,j−1)1 ' −v (i+1,j)
1 . Moreover, when i > 1, we have v (i,1)1 ' 0 and, when j < s,
v (r,j)1 ' 0.
5.2. MORPHISMS BETWEEN R-DIMENSIONAL BAND COMPLEXES 123
Proof. The homotopy equivalences are obtained by lifting h to each pair of layers
(i, j).
Repeated application of Lemma 5.2.12 yields the following homotopy equivalences:
v (1,1)1 ' −v (2,2)
1 ' v (3,3)1 ' · · · ' ±v (s,s)
1 ;
v (1,2)1 ' −v (2,3)
1 ' v (3,4)1 ' · · · ' ±v (s−1,s)
1 ;
...
v (1,s)1 .
where we interpret v (i,j) as 0 whenever i > r or j > s. So if r ≥ s then above
homotopy equivalences do not produce any null-homotopy classes. In this case there
are s non-null homotopy classes.
If r < s, then the first s − r homotopy classes are null-homotopic. In this case
there are s− (s− r) = r non-null homotopy classes.
All lifts of v1 that are not listed above can be seen to be null-homotopic with
another application of Lemma 5.2.12. If r ≥ s then we have 0 ' v (i,1)1 ' −v (i+1,2)
1 '
v (i+2,3)1 ' · · · ' ±v (r,s+2−i)
1 for 2 ≤ i ≤ r. If r < s then we have 0 ' v (i,1)1 ' −v (i+1,2)
1 '
v (i+2,3)1 ' · · · ' ±v (r,r+1−i)
1 for 2 ≤ i ≤ r.
We have shown that the lifts of this exceptional graph homotopy yield min{r, s}
linearly independent homotopy classes in HomKb,−(BV ,k,r,ΣBV ,k,s). We are now ready
to prove the main theorem of this section.
Theorem 5.2.13. Let r, s ∈ N, V ,W ∈ HBa, and k, l ∈ k∗. Also let
d = dim HomKb,−(BV ,k,1, BW ,l,1).
1. If BV ,k,1 is not isomorphic to BW ,l,1 nor Σ−1BW ,l,1, then
dim HomKb,−(BV ,k,r, BW ,l,s) = rs(d).
2. If BV ,k,1∼= BW ,l,1 or BV ,k,1
∼= Σ−1BW ,l,1, then
dim HomKb,−(BV ,k,r, BW ,l,s) = rs(d− 1) + min{r, s}.
Proof. By Lemma 5.2.3, the set BCV ,W spans HomKb,−(BV ,k,r, BW ,l,s). Moreover we
have observed that all homotopies between morphisms in HomKb,−(BV ,k,r, BW ,l,s) will
124 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
decompose into a linear combination of lifts of graph homotopies. Thus it remains
to determine how many linearly independent homotopy classes are produced by lifts
of maximal graph homotopies. We consider the cases set out in the statement of the
lemma.
1. The fact that every class H(f) in HomKb,−(BV ,k,1, BW ,l,1) gives rise to rs linearly
independent homotopy classes in HomKb,−(BV ,k,r, BW ,l,s) is immediate from Lem-
mas 5.2.4, 5.2.5, 5.2.8 and 5.2.10.
2. If BV ,k,1∼= BW ,l,1 then, again, the result is immediate from Lemma 5.2.3 (2) and
the combination of Lemmas 5.2.4, 5.2.5, 5.2.8 and 5.2.10.
If BV ,k,1∼= Σ−1BW ,l,1 then the result follows from Lemmas 5.2.4 and 5.2.5 as well
as Lemma 5.2.12 and the discussion that follows it.
Finally, we note that slight adaptations of the above arguments where r = 1 or s =
1 will yield analogous results for morphisms between r-dimensional band complexes
and string complexes. We may therefore extend the above theorem as follows.
Theorem 5.2.14. Let r ∈ N, V ∈ HBa, W ∈ HSt ∪ HRes and let k ∈ k∗. Then
dim HomKb,−(BV ,k,r, PW ) = rs dim HomKb,−(BV ,k,1, PW )
and
dim HomKb,−(PW , BV ,k,r) = rs dim HomKb,−(PW , BV ,k,1).
5.3 Application: The homotopy category of a derived-
discrete algebra
In this final section of Chapter 5, we will apply our results to string complexes in the
homotopy category of gentle algebras whose derived category is discrete.
If A is a finite-dimensional algebra and X is an object in Db(A-mod) then let
DimX := (dimH i(X))i∈Z where dimH i(X) is the dimension vector of H i(X) for each
i ∈ Z. That is, DimX ∈ K0(A)(Z) where K0(A) is the Grothendieck group of A-mod.
5.3. HOMOTOPY CATEGORY OF A DERIVED-DISCRETE ALGEBRA 125
In [57] Vossieck defines Db(A-mod) to be a discrete derived category if every
positive x ∈ K0(A)(Z) there are only finitely many isomorphism classes of indecom-
posable objects X in Db(A-mod) with DimX = x. In this case we say that A is a
derived-discrete algebra.
In [13] the derived-discrete algebras are classified up to derived equivalence. That
is, a finite-dimensional algebra A over an algebraically closed field k has a discrete
derived category if and only if it is derived equivalent to either
1. an algebra of finite representation type i.e. A is piece-wise hereditary of Dynkin
type; or
2. an algebra Λ(r, n,m), for 1 ≤ r ≤ n and m ≥ 0, given by the following quiver
with relations indicated by dotted lines.
−m −m+ 1 · · · −1 0a−m a−1
1
n− 1
2
n− 2
n− r
n− r + 2
n− r + 1
b0
b1
bn−r
cn−r+1cn−1
cn−2
In the remainder of this thesis we will use the term derived-discrete algebra to
refer to algebras with quivers Λ(r, n,m) since they will be our primary object of study.
We do not consider the piece-wise hereditary algebras of Dynkin type since their
representation theory is well-understood.
In Chapter 7 and Chapter 8 we will prove a series of results about the homotopy
category K(Λ-Proj) for Λ = Λ(r, n,m), 1 ≤ r ≤ n and m ≥ 0. The full subcategory
K(Λ-Proj)c of compact objects is equivalent to Db(Λ-mod) and so it follows that our
results will apply to K(A-Proj) for any derived-discrete algebra A.
Let 1 ≤ r ≤ n and m ≥ 0. We will eventually show that all of the indecomposable
objects in K(Λ-Proj) are string complexes of the kind described in Section 4.2.1. The
form of the quiver means that there are no homotopy bands over Λ and the form of
the homotopy strings is quite limited.
Lemma 5.3.1. Let 1 ≤ r ≤ n and m ≥ 0. (Up to equivalence) the homotopy strings
over the derived-discrete algebra Λ(r, n,m) are shifted copies of subwords of the fol-
lowing strings.
126 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
1. • ◦a−1...a−moo Vk // ◦ cn−1 // . . .cn−1+1 // •
bn−r...b0a−1...a−m// •
2. • ◦a−1...a−moo V // ◦ V // ◦ V // ◦ //
3. // ◦ V // ◦ V // ◦ cn−1 // . . .cn−1+1 // •
bn−r...b0a−1...a−m// •
4. // ◦ V // ◦ V // ◦ V // ◦ //
where V is the homotopy string with unfolded diagram • cn−1 // . . .cn−1+1 // •
bn−r...b0// • and
Vk is the concatenation of k copies of V . When r = n we set b0 = c0.
Remark 5.3.2. Recall Remark 4.2.5 in which we consider infinite string complexes.
For Λ(r, n,m) the condition that there are only finitely many indecomposable sum-
mands in each degree is satisfied by all the possible infinite homotopy strings W and
so we can consider the associated string compexes PW . Moreover, the results in the
previous chapter hold for morphisms from and to such infinite string complexes.
Proposition 5.3.3. Let Λ = Λ(r, n,m) for some 1 ≤ r ≤ n and m ≥ 0.
1. If Λ has finite global dimension, then the indecomposable compact objects in
K(Λ-Proj) are the string complexes PW where W is a finite homotopy string.
2. If Λ has infinite global dimension, then the indecomposable compact objects in
K(Λ-Proj) are the string complexes PW such that W is either a right infinite
substring of (2) in Lemma 5.3.1 or a finite homotopy string.
Proof. In [27] Jørgensen describes the compact objects for the category K(R-Proj)
where R is a coherent ring where all flat modules have finite projective dimension.
Since Λ is a finite-dimensional algebra it satisfies these conditions: it is coherent and
every flat module is projective. We consider Jørgensen’s construction for Λ.
Let (−)∗ = HomΛ(−,Λ) be the well-known duality between left and right projective
Λ-modules. Let M be a finite-dimensional left Λ-module and consider the projective
resolution PM of M∗. This can be considered as complex in Kb,−(Λop
-proj). We can
also consider the complex P ∗M .
Let G := {∑i P ∗M | M ∈ Λ
op-mod, i ∈ Z} and let C be the thick subcategory of
K(Λ-Proj) generated by G. If D is the thick subcategory of K(Λop
-Proj) generated by
5.3. HOMOTOPY CATEGORY OF A DERIVED-DISCRETE ALGEBRA 127
{G∗ | G ∈ G}, then by [27, Thm. 3.2]
C(−)∗ // D(−)∗oo
are quasi-inverse equivalences of triangulated categories. Moreover, it is shown that D
is the thick subcategory generated by the set of projective resolutions PN of modules
N in Λop
-mod. That is D = Kb,−(Λop
-proj) and the indecomposable complexes are
exactly string complexes PU where U is either a finite string or U = ∞W where W is a
primitive left resolvable string over Λop
. The duality (−)∗ sends the string complexes
PU to the string complexes described in the statement of the proposition.
5.3.1 A bound on the dimension of Hom(PV , PW )
As an application of the results in this section, we are able to use homotopy string
combinatorics to extend a result found in [15], that is, the bound on the dimension
of the spaces of morphisms between indecomposable objects in Kb,−(Λ-proj) when
Λ = Λ(r, n,m). We extend this result to the infinite global dimension case and also
to include morphisms in K(Λ-Proj) to and from string complexes PV when V may be
an infinite string.
Lemma 5.3.4. If r > 1, we have dim HomΛ(P (i), P (j)) ≤ 1 for all −m ≤ i, j ≤ n−1.
If r = 1 then the bound is as above except we have dim HomΛ(P (0), P (j)) = 2 for all
−m ≤ j ≤ 0.
Proof. This follows directly from the form of the quiver and Observation 4.1.2.
As in previous sections, we use the terminology “v does not exist” to mean that
the string ends before this homotopy letter; in the diagram the dotted lines indicate
that the homotopy letter may not exist.
Lemma 5.3.5. Let V and W be (possibly infinite) homotopy strings and consider the
following unfolded diagram.
v ′L • vL
fL��
•1��
up •1��
up−1 · · · u2 •1 ��
u1 •1 ��
vR •v ′R
fR��
w ′L• wL
• up • up−1· · · u2 • u1 • •wR w ′R
128 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
1. Suppose the diagram represents a maximal graph homotopy.
(a) If vL exists, then at least one of v ′L or w ′L does not exist.
(b) If vR exists, then at least one of v ′R or w ′R does not exist.
2. Suppose the diagram represents a graph map. Then at least one of v ′L and w ′L
does not exist and at least one of v ′R and w ′R does not exist.
Proof. 1. We give the argument for statement (a); the argument for (b) is com-
pletely dual. By definition of a maximal graph homotopy, if vL exists then
vL 6= wL. If wL does not exist then clearly w ′L does not exist. If wL does exist,
then the form of the strings mean that vL or wL (or both) must be a substring
of bn−r · · · b0a−1 . . . a−m and in this case v ′L or w ′L respectively cannot exist.
2. We only consider the left end of the string; the argument for the right end is
similar. If fL exists then vL and wL are oriented in the same direction but are
not equal. Again vL or wL (or both) must be a substring of bn−r · · · b0a−1 . . . a−m
and so at least one of w ′L and v ′L does not exist. If fL is zero, then we must have
that vL anf wL are oriented in different directions or one or both of them does
not exist; in the latter case clearly at least one of v ′L or w ′L does not exist. If
both are non-zero then one of them is oriented in the opposite direction to up.
By Lemma 5.3.1, this only occurs at the end of a string, so at least one of v ′L or
w ′L does not exist.
Remark 5.3.6. The idea of this lemma is that, for any graph map PV → PW or
maximal graph homotopy between single and double maps PV → PW , the common
part of the relevant unfolded diagrams spans every degree where PV and PW are non-
zero. The same will be true for single and double maps and so Lemma 5.3.4 combined
with Observation 5.1.10 will imply the bound on the dimension of the hom-spaces.
The diagram in the lemma shows only the case where the common part of the
unfolded diagrams is finite. The proof of the lemma deals with endpoints only so the
result in fact holds for graph maps that are supported in infinitely many degrees. Note
that infinite graph homotopies are always null-homotopies.
5.3. HOMOTOPY CATEGORY OF A DERIVED-DISCRETE ALGEBRA 129
Theorem 5.3.7. Let Λ = Λ(r, n,m) be a derived-discrete algebra and let V and W be
(possibly infinite) homotopy strings. Then the following hold.
1. If r > 1, then dim HomK(PV , PW ) ≤ 1.
2. If r = 1, then dim HomK(PV , PW ) ≤ 2.
Proof. If r > 1 then, by Lemma 5.3.4 and Lemma 5.3.5 combined with Observation
5.1.10, if there exists a graph map or a maximal graph homotopy, then this is the
unique basis morphism PV → PW .
When r = 1, the above considerations apply but, by Lemma 5.3.4, we may also
have that there is a graph map and a homotopy class of single maps given by a maximal
graph homotopy. By the same reasoning as above there can be no other basis maps.
Next we consider the case where there is a single map f : PV → PW such that
H(f) = {f}. Then the form of the stings mean that the only possibility is that f falls
into case (a) of Corollary 5.1.20. Clearly this can be the only such basis morphism.
Finally, the only possible double maps g with H(g) = {g} arise when either V or W
consist of a single homotopy letter i.e. PV or PW is a two-term complex. Again, it is
clear that g can be the only basis morphism from PV to PW in this case.
Example 5.3.8. This example shows the r = 1 case where the upper bound is at-
tained. Consider the derived-discrete algebra Λ = Λ(1, 1, 3). That is, the algebra given
by the quiver
1
b1��
−1a−1 // 0
b0
@@
2b2oo
with the relation b2b0 = 0. If we take the homotopy strings V = (b2b1b0 ·b2b1b0a−1, 2, 4)
and W = (a−1 · b2b1b0 · b2b1b0 · b2b1b0a−1, 2, 4). Then we have the following graph map.
• b2b1b0 //1��
•b2b1b0a−1//
1��
•1��
• •a−1
oob2b1b0
// •b2b1b0
// •b2b1b0
// •
As well as the following maximal graph homotopy.
• b2b1b0 //1��
•b2b1b0a−1//
1��
•
• •a−1
oob2b1b0
// •b2b1b0
// •b2b1b0
// •
130 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
Corollary 5.3.9. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra and let V be a (possibly infinite)
homotopy string. The complex PV indecomposable.
Proof. If V is a finite homotopy string, then PV is known to be indecomposable by
[10]. So assume that V is infinite. From the proof of Theorem 5.3.7, we have that
dim HomK(Λ-Proj)(PV , PV ) = 1 unless there is both a maximal graph homotopy and a
graph map PV → PV . But as the string is infinite the graph homotopy arising in this
way will be supported in infinitely many degrees and so will be a null-homotopy. Thus
HomK(Λ-Proj)(PV , PV ) = k and since the category K(Λ-Proj) is idempotent complete,
it follows that PV is indecomposable.
5.3.2 The category when gldim Λ <∞
The algebra Λ = Λ(r, n,m) has finite global dimension if and only if r < n [13].
The bounded derived category in the finite and infinite global dimension cases have
slightly different structure; in this section we describe the structure of Db(Λ-mod) for
gldim Λ <∞ and in the next section we describe Db(Λ-mod) for gldim Λ =∞.
In [13], the authors describe the form of the components of the Auslander-Reiten
quiver of Db(Λ-mod). Here we extend this description to the category add(StrΛ)
where StrΛ is the collection of all indecomposable string objects in K(Λ-Proj) and
add(StrΛ) is the closure of StrΛ under finite direct sums and summands. In particular
we describe a quiver where the vertices are indecomposable string complexes and the
arrows are the irreducible morphisms between them. This description is obtained via
an application of [1, Sec. 6] where the irreducible morphisms between string complexes
are described; this argument is due to K. Arnesen.
Remark 5.3.10. Let A be a gentle algebra. A description of the AR triangles in
Kb(A-proj) is first given in [12]. In [1] our description of morphisms between string
complexes in Kb,−(A-proj) is used to extend this description to include unbounded
complexes in Kb,−(A-proj). The argument actually applies to all indecomposable
string complexes in K(Λ-Proj) (since they are finite-dimensional in each degree, see
Remark 5.3.2).
The Auslander-Reiten quiver of add(StrΛ) consists of 8r components. For each
5.3. HOMOTOPY CATEGORY OF A DERIVED-DISCRETE ALGEBRA 131
k ∈ {0, 1, · · · , r − 1} we have components
X k−∞,X k
∞,Yk−∞,Yk∞
of type A∞∞ and Zk∞ of type A1, all containing infinite string complexes. Moreover the
finite string complexes are contained in components
X k,Yk
of type ZA∞ and Zk of type ZA∞. The components can be seen to fit together as
follows.
Y0 X 1 Y2
X 0 Y1 X 2
Z0 Z1 Z2Zr−1
The A∞∞ component to the left of X 0 is X 0−∞ and to the right is X 0
∞. Similarly, the
A∞∞ component to the left of Y0 is Y0−∞ and to the right is Y0
∞. The component of
type A1 (that is, the single vertex) between X 0 and Y0 is Z0∞. The configuration for
k > 0 is similar (though ‘upside-down’ for odd k).
It is also necessary to fix an indexing of the indecomposable objects of add(StrΛ).
The indexing we choose is consistent with [13] and also [15]. First we fix how the
objects in specific components are labelled:
Xi,j ∈ X k with i, j ∈ Z and j ≥ i;
Y ki,j ∈ Yk with i.j ∈ Z and j ≤ i;
Zi,j ∈ Zk with i, j ∈ Z;
Xi,∞ ∈ X k∞ with i ∈ Z;
X−∞,i ∈ X k−∞ with i ∈ Z;
Yi,∞ ∈ Yk∞ with i ∈ Z;
132 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
Y−∞,i ∈ Yk−∞ with i ∈ Z;
Zk∞ ∈ Zk∞.
The following diagram indicates how the indexing looks in the Auslander-Reiten
quiver.
Y k(−1,−1)
��
Y k(0,0)
��
Y k(1,1)
��. . .
��
...
??
Y k(0,−1)
��
??
Y k(1,0)
��
??. . . ...
Y k(−1,−∞)
��
...
??
Y k(1,−1)
��
??. . . Y k
(∞,1)
??
Y k(0,−∞)
��
...
??. . . Y k
(∞,0)
??. . .
��
...
Y k(1,−∞)
��
Y k(∞,−1)
??. . .
��
Zk(−1,1)
��
??
...
. . . ...
??. . .
��
Zk(−1,0)
��
??
Zk(0,1)
��
??
...
Zk∞ Zk
(−1,−1)
��
??
Zk(0,0)
��
??
Zk(1,1)
��
??
... . . .
��
... Zk(0,−1)
��
??
Zk(1,0)
��
??. . .
Xk(−∞,1)
??
Xk(−1,∞)
��
... Zk(1,−1)
��
??. . .
Xk(−∞,0)
??. . .
��
... Xk(0,∞)
��
...
??. . .
Xk(−∞,−1)
??. . .
��
Xk(−1,1)
��
??
... Xk(1,∞)
��...
??. . .
��
Xk(−1,0)
��
??
Xk(0,1)
��
??
... . . .
Xk(−1,−1)
??
Xk(0,0)
??
Xk(1,1)
??
The morphisms between these objects all travel from left to right and ‘wrap around’
so that the components form a cylinder or a mobius strip (depending on the parity
of r). In [15] the so-called ‘Hom-hammocks’ in the category Db(Λ-mod) (for Λ with
finite global dimension) are described.
Remark 5.3.11. The hammock poset H(x) (for x ∈ Q0) defined in Section 2.4.5 is
the forward Hom-hammocks of the projective cover P (x) of the simple module S(x).
In the next result we describe these hom-hammocks and also extend them to include
the infinite string complexes; the proof that these are indeed the hom-hammocks (for
5.3. HOMOTOPY CATEGORY OF A DERIVED-DISCRETE ALGEBRA 133
both the infinite and finite global dimension case) can be found in [2, Sec. 3] and the
argument is due to D. Pauksztello.
For M ∈ StrΛ, we define the Hom-hammocks
H+∞(M) := {X ∈ StrΛ | HomK(M,X) 6= 0} the forward Hom-hammock of A;
H−∞(M) := {X ∈ StrΛ | HomK(X,M) 6= 0} the backward Hom-hammock of A.
Proposition 5.3.12 ([2, Prop. 3.12]). Suppose Λ is derived-discrete with finite global
dimension. Let a, b ∈ Z and 0 ≤ k < r. The forward Hom-hammocks of objects of
StrΛ are given by:
H+∞(Xk
a,b) = H+(Xka,b) ∪ {Xk
i,∞ | a ≤ i ≤ b} ∪ {Xk+1−∞,j | a′ − 1 ≤ j ≤ b′ − 1};
H+∞(Y k
a,b) = H+(Y ka,b) ∪ {Y k
∞,j | b ≤ j ≤ a} ∪ {Y k+1i,−∞ | b′′ − 1 ≤ i ≤ a′′ − 1};
H+∞(Zk
a,b) = H+(Zka,b) ∪ {Xk+1
−∞,j | j ≥ a′ − 1} ∪ {Xk+1i,∞ | i ≤ a′ − 1}
∪ {Zk+1∞ } ∪ {Y k+1
i,−∞ | i ≥ b′′ − 1} ∪ {Y k+1∞,j | j ≤ b′′ − 1};
H+∞(Xk
a,∞) = {Xki,∞ | i ≥ a} ∪ {Zk
i,j | i ≥ a and j ∈ Z} ∪ {Xk+1−∞,j | j ≥ a′ − 1}
∪ {Xk+1i,j | i ≤ a′ − 1 and j ≥ a′ − 1};
H+∞(Xk
−∞,b) = {Xk−∞,j | j ≥ b} ∪ {Xk
i,j | i ≤ b and j ≥ b} ∪ {Xki,∞ | i ≤ b}
∪ {Y k∞,j | j ∈ Z} ∪ {Zk
i,j | i ≤ b and j ∈ Z} ∪ {Zk∞};
H+∞(Y k
∞,b) = {Y k∞,j | j ≥ b} ∪ {Zk
i,j | i ∈ Z and j ≥ b} ∪ {Y k+1i,−∞ | i ≥ b′′ − 1}
∪ {Y k+1i,j | i ≥ b′′ − 1 and j ≤ b′′ − 1};
H+∞(Y k
a,−∞) = {Y ki,−∞ | i ≥ a} ∪ {Y k
i,j | i ≥ a and j ≤ a} ∪ {Y k∞,j | j ≤ a}
∪ {Xki,∞ | i ∈ Z} ∪ {Zk
i,j | i ∈ Z and j ≤ a} ∪ {Zk∞};
H+∞(Zk
∞) = {Xki,∞ | i ∈ Z} ∪ {Y k
∞,j | j ∈ Z} ∪ {Zki,j | i, j ∈ Z}.
where for a ∈ Z we set
a′ =
a+ r +m if k = r − 1;
a otherwise,a′′ =
a+ r − n if k = r − 1;
a otherwise.
134 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
These sets can be best understood via the following diagrams.
X
Z
Y0 X 1 Y2
X 0 Y1 X 2
Z0 Z1 Z2
X0a,∞ X2
−∞,b
Y0 X 1 Y2
X 0 Y1 X 2
Z0 Z1 Z2
We can also easily identify which strings arise in the various components of the
quiver. Let X denote the subcategoryr−1⋃k=0
X k etc. Then the finite strings are contained
in X ∪Y ∪Z; the (right) infinite substrings of string (2) in Lemma 5.3.1 are contained
in X∞ ∪ Y−∞; the (left) infinite substrings of string (3) in Lemma 5.3.1 are contained
in X−∞ ∪Y∞; and the shifts of the (two-sided) infinite string (4) are contained in Z∞.
5.3.3 The category when gldim Λ =∞
Next we give a similar description of the Auslander-Reiten quiver for Λ = Λ(r, n,m)
with gldim Λ = ∞ i.e. when r = n. The description of the form of the Auslander-
Reiten components of Db(Λ-mod) ' Kb,−(Λ-proj) can be found in [13]. Again we
extend this description to add(StrΛ) via [1, Sec. 6].
The Auslander-Reiten quiver of StrΛ consists of 3r components. For each k ∈
{0, · · · , r − 1} there is a component X k of type ZA∞. There is also a ‘ladder-type’
component Zk:
5.3. HOMOTOPY CATEGORY OF A DERIVED-DISCRETE ALGEBRA 135
��
��
Zki−1
��Xki−1,∞
??
��
Zki
��Xki,∞
��
??
Zki+1
��Xki+1,∞
��
??
We will label the right-hand ‘beam’ of the ladder by Zk and the left-hand ‘beam’
by X k∞. Finally there is a component Zk∞ of type A1. The components X k and Zk
make up the Auslander-Reiten quiver of Db(Λ-mod).
The morphisms in the category mean that components can be seen to fit together
as follows
X 0
X 1
X 2
X 3
X 4
X r−1
The ladder Z0 is above and to the right of X 0; the remaining ladder-type compo-
nents for k > 0 are labelled similarly but are ‘upside-down’ for odd k. Again, there
are morphisms from the components labelled by r−1 into the components labelled by
0 and so the global structure of the category resembles a cylinder or a mobius strip,
depending on the parity of r.
As before, we fix an indexing on the objects of StrΛ and it is consistent with [13].
For each 0 ≤ k ≤ r − 1, we have:
Xki,j ∈ X k with i, j ∈ Z and j ≥ i;
Xki,∞ ∈ X k
∞ with i ∈ Z;
Zki ∈ Zk with i ∈ Z;
Zk∞ ∈ Zk∞ with i ∈ Z.
136 CHAPTER 5. MORPHISMS BETWEEN INDECOMPOSABLE COMPLEXES
The indexing fits into the Auslander-Reiten quiver as follows.
Zk∞
. . .
��. . .
��
Zki−1
��Xki−1,∞
??
��
Zki
��. . .
��
... Xki,∞
��
??
Zki+1
��. . .
��
Xki−1,i+1
??
��
... Xki+1,∞
��
??
. . .
. . .
��
Xki−1,i
??
��
Xki,i+1
??
��
... . . .
Xki−1,i−1
??
Xki,i
??
Xki+1,i+1
??
Proposition 5.3.13 ([2, Prop. 3.16]). Suppose Λ is derived-discrete with infinite global
dimension. Let a ≤ b ∈ Z and 0 ≤ k < r. The forward Hom-hammocks of objects of
StrΛ are given by:
H+∞(Xk
a,b) = H+(Xka,b) ∪ {Xk
i,∞ | a ≤ i ≤ b};
H+∞(Zk
a ) = H+(Zka ) ∪ {Zk+1
∞ } ∪ {Xk+1i,∞ | i ≤ a′ − 1};
H+∞(Xk
a,∞) = H+(Zka ) ∪ {Zk+1
∞ } ∪ {Xki,∞ | i ≥ a}.
Moreover, for 0 ≤ k < r:
H−∞(Xka,∞) = H+
∞(Zk−1a ) and H−∞(Zk
a ) = H−(Zka ) ∪ {Zk
∞} ∪ {Xki,∞ | i ≤ a},
where a =
a− r −m if k = 0;
a otherwise.
As before, these regions can be understood more easily via the following diagrams.
X 0
X 1
X 2
X 3
X 4
X r−1
X 0
X 1
X 2
X 3
X 4
X r−1
5.3. HOMOTOPY CATEGORY OF A DERIVED-DISCRETE ALGEBRA 137
Again we can identify which strings occur in which component of the Auslander-
Reiten quiver. Let X denoter−1⋃k=0
X k etc. Complexes given by finite strings are con-
tained in X ; the (right) infinite substrings of string (3) in Lemma 5.3.1 are contained
in Z; the (left) infinite substrings of string (2) are contained in X∞; and the shifts of
the two-sided infinite string (4) are the indecomposable complexes in Z∞.
The bound on the dimension of the Hom-spaces as well as the structure of the
Hom-hammocks mean that the mesh relations within the components extend across
components in the obvious way. This will be an incredibly useful result. Again, the
argument for this property is due to D. Pauksztello.
Proposition 5.3.14 ([2, Prop. 31.6]). Let A,B,C ∈ StrΛ. If B is in H+∞(A) and C
is in H+∞(A) ∩ H+
∞(B), then any map f : A→ C factors as A→ B → C.
Chapter 6
The Ziegler spectrum of a
compactly generated triangulated
category
In this chapter we outline how the techniques described in Chapter 1 may be applied
to the setting of a compactly generated triangulated category. The definitions for
purity and the Ziegler spectrum in a compactly generated triangulated category were
first given by Krause in [33] and also Beligiannis in [11]. We will show here that the
functor category used in these definitions is equivalent to a localisation of the usual
functor category (that is, as we defined it in Chapter 1). Moreover, it follows there is a
homeomorphism between the Ziegler spectrum of a compactly generated triangulated
category and a closed subset of the Ziegler spectrum of a module category. We may
then apply all the results stated in Chapter 1 to the triangulated setting.
6.1 Compactly generated triangulated categories
Let T be a triangulated category with suspension functor Σ: T→ T. Then we say an
object C in T is compact if the canonical morphism
HomT(C,⊕i∈I
Di)→⊕i∈I
HomT(C,Di)
is an isomorphism for any set {Di | i ∈ I} of objects in T. We denote the full
(triangulated) subcategory of compact objects in T by Tc. Suppose Tc is skeletally
138
6.2. THE ZIEGLER SPECTRUM OF T 139
small and for every non-zero object D in T, there is a non-zero morphism C → D for
some compact object C, then we say that T is compactly generated.
Example 6.1.1. Let R be a ring. The category K(R-Proj) is compactly generated
and the subcategory of compact objects K(R-Proj)c is equivalent to Db(mod-R)op
(see
[39, Thm. 1.1] which extends the results in [27]).
Example 6.1.2. Let R be a ring and let D(R-Mod) be the derived category of R.
Then D(R-Mod) is a compactly generated triangulated category and the compact
objects are exactly those contained in the canonical copy of Kb(R-proj).
6.2 The Ziegler spectrum of a compactly generated
triangulated category
Let T be a compactly generated triangulated category with full subcategory Tc of
compact objects. Consider the category
Mod-Tc = ((Tc)op
,Ab)
of contravariant functors from Tc to the category Ab of abelian groups. Then let
Y : T→ Mod-Tc be the functor that takes objects N ∈ T to (−, N)∣∣Tc and morphisms
f : M → N to (−, f)∣∣Tc . We refer to the functor Y as the restricted Yoneda
functor. If the context is clear, we will simply write (−, N) for (−, N)∣∣Tc and (−f)
for (−, f)∣∣Tc .
We say that a monomorphism in T is pure if Y (f) = (−, f) is a monomorphism
in Mod-Tc. If an object M ∈ T is injective over all pure monomorphisms, then we
say that N is pure-injective. That is, for every pure monomorphism f : M → L
and every morphism g : M → N , there exists a morphism h : L → N such that the
following diagram commutes.
Mf //
g��
L
h~~N
In fact, there are several equivalent ways of characterising the pure-injective objects
in T, we give a summary in the following proposition.
140 CHAPTER 6. MODEL THEORY IN A TRIANGULATED CATEGORY
Proposition 6.2.1 ([33, Sec. 1.4]). Let M be an object in a compactly generated
triangulated category T. Then the following conditions are equivalent:
1. The object M is pure-injective in T.
2. The functor (−,M) is injective in Mod-Tc.
3. For every object N in T, the induced morphism (N,M) → ((−, N), (−,M)) is
an isomorphism.
Moreover, the second condition leads to a slightly stronger statement.
Proposition 6.2.2 ([33, Cor. 1.9]). Let T be a compactly generated triangulated cat-
egory. Then the restricted Yoneda functor induces an equivalence of categories
Pinj(T) ' Inj(Mod-Tc)
where Pinj(T) is the full subcategory of T consisting of pure-injective objects and
Inj(Mod-Tc) is the full subcategory of Mod-Tc consisting of injective objects.
As we did in Section 1.2 of Part I in the module category, we will define a topology
on the isomorphism classes of indecomposable pure-injective objects in T. Let F be
a covariant functor from T to Ab. We say that F is coherent if there exists a exact
sequence of functors
(B,−)→ (A,−)→ F → 0
where A and B are compact objects (and (B,−) and (A,−) are the unrestricted
covariant hom-functors).
We then define the Ziegler spectrum Zg(T) of T to be the topological space
with points given by isomorphism classes of pure-injective objects in T and a basis of
(compact) open sets
(F ) := {M ∈ Zg(T) | F (M) 6= 0}
for each coherent functor F .
As before, the closed subsets of Zg(T) correspond to the definable subcategories of
T. A full subcategory D of T is said to be definable if there is a family {Fi | i ∈ Φ}
of coherent functors such that
D = {M ∈ T | Fi(M) = 0 for all i ∈ Φ}.
The closed sets of Zg(T) are exactly those of the form D∩Zg(T) (see [35, Prop. 7.3]).
6.3. HOMEOMORPHISM BETWEEN ZG(T) AND ZG(ABS-TC) 141
6.3 Homeomorphism between Zg(T) and Zg(Abs-Tc)
In this section we will show that there is a homeomorphism between Zg(T) and the
closed subset of Zg(Mod-Tc) containing only absolutely pure objects (in fact, this is
exactly the collection of indecomposable injective functors). This means that we can
apply the results stated in Part I Section 1.2 to Zg(T).
For any skeletally small additive category R, an object F ∈ Mod-R is called
absolutely pure if every monomorphism F → G in R-Mod is a pure monomorphism.
Let Abs-Tc denote the full subcategory of Mod-Tc consisting of the absolutely pure
objects. The following equivalent properties are well-known, see for example [44,
Prop. 2.3.1].
Proposition 6.3.1. Let R be a skeletally small preadditive category. Then, for each
F in Mod-R, the following are equivalent.
1. F is absolutely pure.
2. F is injective over all monomorphisms τ : G → H such that coker(τ) is finitely
presented. An object with this property is known as fp injective.
3. Ext1(G,F ) = 0 for all G in R-mod.
Since Tc is triangulated, we have the following additional characterisation of absolutely
pure objects in Tc-Mod.
Proposition 6.3.2 ([33, Lem.2.7]). A functor F in Mod-Tc is absolutely pure if and
only if it is flat. In particular, it is the direct limit of representable functors.
Lemma 6.3.3 ([35, Lem. 7.2]). Let T be a compactly generated triangulated category.
Then there is an equivalence of categories
(mod-Tc)op ∼−→ Coh(T)
taking a functor F to the functor F∨ where F∨(M) := (F, (−,M)) for each object M
in T.
Since mod-Tc is abelian, we have that Mod-Tc is locally coherent (by Proposition
1.0.4). It therefore follows that Abs-Tc is definable (see [44, Thm. 3.4.24]). Thus let
Zg(Abs-Tc) denote the closed subset Abs-Tc ∩ Zg(Mod-Tc) with the subset topology.
142 CHAPTER 6. MODEL THEORY IN A TRIANGULATED CATEGORY
Theorem 6.3.4. There is a homeomorphism Zg(T)∼→ Zg(Abs-Tc) given by the fol-
lowing assignment N 7→ (−, N).
Proof. By Proposition 6.2.2, the assignment N 7→ (−, N) is a bijection between the
points of Zg(T) and Zg(Abs-Tc). We will show that this bijection is a homeomorphism.
The basic open sets of Zg(Abs-Tc) are (G) where G is an object of the localisation
(mod-Tc,Ab)fp/ann(Z) and Z = Zg(Abs-Tc) (see Section 1.3.4 for notation). By [44,
Thm. 18.1.4], the definable subcategory Abs-Tc is equivalent to the category of exact
functors from (mod-Tc,Ab)fp/ann(Z) to Ab and the latter is determined by Abs-Tc
up to natural equivalence. But in [45, Thm. 7.2] it is shown that the category of
exact functors from (mod-Tc)op
to Ab is equivalent to Abs-Tc. It therefore follows
that (mod-Tc)op
is equivalent to (mod-Tc,Ab)fp/ann(Z). We can use this equiva-
lence to characterise the open sets (G) in terms of isomorphism classes of objects in
mod-Tc. It is implicit in [45] that A ∈ (mod-Tc)op
is taken to the image of (A,−) in
(mod-Tc,Ab)fp/ann(Z) (since (A,−) is dual to A⊗Tc −). It follows that we can take
the basic open sets of Zg(Abs-Tc) to be
{(−, N) ∈ Zg(Abs-Tc) | (A, (−, N)) 6= 0}
for A in mod-Tc.
The equivalence in Lemma 6.3.3 gives us that for all F in Coh(T), there is a A in
mod-Tc such that F = A∨. The corresponding open set (F ) is
{N ∈ Zg(T) | F (N) 6= 0} = {N ∈ Zg(T) | (A, (−, N)) 6= 0}.
It is immediate from this that N 7→ (−, N) is a homeomorphism.
Recall that a typical object G in Coh(T) has a presentation
(D,−)→ (C,−)→ G→ 0
where C,D ∈ Tc. Since the Yoneda functor is full, there must be some f : C → D such
that G = coker(f,−); then we will denote G by Ff . Using the above, we ca explicitly
describe the form of F ∈ Tc-mod when F∨ = Ff .
Corollary 6.3.5. Consider the equivalence of Lemma 6.3.3 above. Suppose F∨ = Ff
for some f : C → D in Tc. Then there is an exact sequence
0 −→ F −→ (−, C)(−,f)−→ (−, D).
6.4. Σ-PURE-INJECTIVE OBJECTS 143
Proof. Suppose, under the equivalence of Lemma 6.3.3, we have F∨ = Ff for some
f : C → D in Tc. We have that (−, D)∨ = (D,−) whenever D is a compact object
since ((−, D), (−,M)) ∼= (D,M) for any M in T. We can rewrite the exact sequence
(D,−)(f,−)−→ (C,−) −→ Ff −→ 0 as (−, D)∨
(−,f)∨−→ (−, C)∨ −→ F∨ −→ 0
and so 0 −→ F −→ (−, C)(−,f)−→ (−, D) is also exact.
6.4 Σ-pure-injective objects
In this section we summarise some background on Σ-pure-injective objects in trian-
gulated categories. Given the above homeomorphism we may apply some standard
results for Σ-pure-injective modules to this setting. These results will be central to
the arguments in Section 8.1.
An object of T is Σ-pure-injective if the coproduct N (I) is pure-injective for any
(possibly infinite) set I. Equivalently, N is Σ-pure-injective if and only if for each
C ∈ Tc, the EndT(N)-module HomT(C,N) satisfies the descending chain condition on
EndT(N)-submodules.
In practice it is often easier to prove the stronger property of having finite en-
dolength (of course, only when such a property applies). An object M in a compactly
generated triangulated category T has finite endolength if the left End(M)-module
HomT(C,M) is finite length for all compact objects C in T (see [35]).
Remark 6.4.1. The equivalences described in Section 6.3 allow us to make use of the
following standard results about Σ-pure-injective modules.
• Any object of finite endolength is Σ-pure-injective [44, Cor. 4.4.24].
• A direct sum of finitely many Σ-pure-injective objects is Σ-pure-injective [44,
Lem. 4.4.26].
• If M is a Σ-pure-injective object, then every object in 〈M〉 is Σ-pure-injective
[44, Prop. 4.4.27].
The bound on the dimension of the Hom-spaces between indecomposable string
complexes (Theorem 5.3.7) imply that the string complexes PV are pure-injective.
144 CHAPTER 6. MODEL THEORY IN A TRIANGULATED CATEGORY
Corollary 6.4.2. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra and let V be a (possibly infinite)
homotopy string. The complex PV has finite endolength and is therefore pure-injective
and indecomposable.
Proof. This is immediate from Corollary 5.3.9, the bounds given in Theorem 5.3.7 as
well as the description of the compact objects given in Proposition 5.3.3.
6.5 Localisation with respect to closed subsets
The connections we have made between the various categories involved in this set up
all interact well with the localisations described in Section 1.3.5. In this section we
will summarise the bijections implicit in the previous section; starting with a closed
subset X of Zg(T) we will list the subcategories determined by X.
• A closed subset X of Zg(T).
• The closed subset {(−, X) | X ∈ X} of Zg(Abs-Tc).
• The Serre subcategory {F | F ((−, X)) = 0 for all X ∈ X} of the category
(mod-Tc,Ab)fp/ann(Z) where Z = Zg(Abs-Tc).
• The Serre subcategory S = {A ∈ mod-Tc | (A, (−, X)) = 0 for all X ∈ X} of
mod-Tc.
• The Serre subcategory
{F ∈ Coh(T) | F = A∨ where A ∈ S} = {F ∈ Coh(T) | F (X) = 0 for all X ∈ X}
in Coh(T).
• The Hereditary torsion pair (−→S , (−→S )⊥) of finite type in Mod-Tc. This is the
torsion pair cogenerated by the set {(−, X) | X ∈ X} of indecomposable injective
objects in Mod-Tc.
Chapter 7
The Ziegler spectrum of the
homotopy category of a
derived-discrete algebra
In this chapter we will be looking at the compactly generated category K(Λ-Proj)
where Λ is a derived discrete algebra. As before we will denote K(Λ-Proj) by K. The
full subcategory of compact objects will be denoted Kc (see Proposition 5.3.3).
In Section 1.3.4, we saw that the if the isolation condition holds for a closed subset
Z of Zg(Mod-Kc) then the Krull-Gabriel analysis of (mod-Kc,Ab)fp/ann(Z) and the
Cantor-Bendixson analysis of Z work in parallel. We begin by showing that the isola-
tion condition holds for Zg(Abs-Kc), the closed subset given by the absolutely pure ob-
jects of Mod-Kc. By Proposition 1.3.9, it is enough to show that the Krull-Gabriel di-
mension of (mod-Kc,Ab)fp/ann(Z) is defined. Given the equivalences of categories de-
scribed in Section 6.3, this is equivalent to the analogous result for Zg(K) and Coh(K);
the definitions made in Chapter 1 can be given in this context, for example, if X is
a closed subset of Zg(K), then ann(X) = {F ∈ Coh(K) | F (M) = 0 for all M ∈ X}.
We will use the notation set up in Section 1.3.
Remark 7.0.1. The proof of [44, Lem. 10.2.2] gives us that we have a lattice iso-
morphism analogous to the one described in Corollary 1.1.3. That is, all coherent
subfunctors of Ff have the form im(h,−)/ im(f,−) for some factorisation f = gh of
f in Kc.
145
146 CHAPTER 7. THE ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
Lemma 7.0.2. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra. Then the Krull-Gabriel dimension
of Coh(K) is defined.
Proof. Let F ∈ Coh(K) and consider the lattice L(F ) of coherent subfunctors of F .
By Remark 7.0.1 and the descriptions of the Hom-hammocks in Propositions 5.3.12
and 5.3.13, it is clear that L(F ) has no densely ordered subset. By Proposition 1.3.4,
it follows that the Krull-Gabriel dimension of Coh(K) is defined.
Corollary 7.0.3. The isolation condition holds for Zg(K) and so the Cantor-Bendixson
rank of Zg(K) is defined and there is a natural bijection
{M ∈ Zg(K) | CB(M) = α} 1−1←→ {F ∈ Coh(K)/Coh(K)α | F is simple}.
The correspondence takes a complex M to the image of a functor that isolates it in
Xα.
We have that Coh(K)α = ann(Xα) where Xα is the closed subset of Zg(K) con-
taining points with Cantor-Bendixson rank greater than or equal to α. For each α, let
qα : Coh(K)→ Coh(K)/ann(Xα) be the corresponding localisation functor.
7.1 Krull-Gabriel analysis of Coh(K)
In this section we will describe the simple functors at each stage of the Krull-Gabriel
analysis of Coh(K). As a result we will prove the following theorem.
Theorem 7.1.1. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra. The Krull-Gabriel dimension of
Coh(K(Λ-Proj)) is 2.
7.1.1 Simple functors in Coh(K)
It is well-known that the simple functors in Coh(K) correspond to the Auslander-
Reiten triangles comprised of compact objects in K; see [5, §2].
Proposition 7.1.2. The simple objects in Coh(K) are exactly those of the form Ff
where Xf→ Y
g→ Z → ΣX is an Auslander-Reiten triangle.
7.1. KRULL-GABRIEL ANALYSIS OF COH(K) 147
7.1.2 Simple functors in Coh(K)/ann(X0)
We begin by identifying a family of morphisms that give rise to simple functors in
Coh(K)/ann(X0) and then we will go on to show that, up to an equivalence relation,
these are in fact all of the simple functors in Coh(K)/ann(X0).
Definition 7.1.3. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra.
1. Suppose gldim Λ < ∞. For 0 ≤ k < r the following morphisms will be referred
to as 1-simple morphisms:
h : Xki,j → Xk
i+1,j ⊕ Zki,t h : Y k
i,j → Y ki,j+1 ⊕ Zk
t,j
h : Zki,j → Zk
i+1,j ⊕Xk+1t,i′−1 h : Zk
i,j → Zki,j+1 ⊕ Y k+1
j′′−1,t
where h =(h1h2
)with h1 6= 0 and h2 6= 0.
2. Suppose gldim Λ = ∞. For 0 ≤ k < r the following morphisms will be referred
to as 1-simple morphisms.
h : Xki,j → Xk
i+1,j ⊕ Zki h : Zk
j → Zkj+1 ⊕Xk+1
i,j′−1
where h =(h1h2
)with h1 6= 0 and h2 6= 0.
From Remark 7.0.1 and our description of morphisms, it is clear that q0(Fh) is a
simple functor if h is a 1-simple morphism. Since these functors are simple, it fol-
lows from Corollary 7.0.3 that there are corresponding indecomposable pure-injective
objects with Cantor-Bendixson rank equal to 1.
Proposition 7.1.4. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra.
1. If gldim Λ = ∞ then the elements of ind(Z) are indecomposable, pure-injective
complexes of Cantor-Bendixson rank 1.
2. If gldim Λ <∞ then the elements of ind(X∞ ∪ X−∞ ∪ Y∞ ∪ Y−∞) are indecom-
posable, pure-injective complexes of Cantor-Bendixson rank 1.
Proof. For each of these complexes there is a 1-simple morphism f such that the
open set corresponding to the functor (X,−)/ im (f,−), where X is the domain of f ,
contains that complex and complexes of Cantor-Bendixson rank 0. So this is imme-
diate from Proposition 7.0.3 together with the description of the Hom-hammocks in
Propositions 5.3.12 and 5.3.13.
148 CHAPTER 7. THE ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
We now wish to show that we have identified the full list of simple functors in
Coh(K)/ann(X0); in order to do this we will first require some preliminary lemmas.
Definition 7.1.5. If h : A→ B1⊕B2 and h′ : C → D1⊕D2 are 1-simple morphisms,
then we say that h ∼ h′ if and only if A and C are contained the same ray and B2
and D2 are contained in the same coray of the AR quiver. This defines an equivalence
relation on the set of 1-simple morphisms.
From the description of the Hom-hammocks in Propositions 5.3.12 and 5.3.13, we
see that (Fh) and (Fg) contain the same pure-injective with Cantor-Bendixson rank 1
exactly when h ∼ g. So the following corollary is immediate from Corollary 7.0.3 and
inspection of the Hom-hammocks.
Corollary 7.1.6. Let h and g be 1-simple morphisms. Then, q0(Fh) = q0(Fg) if and
only if h ∼ g.
Lemma 7.1.7. Let T be a compactly generated triangulated category and let f : A→ B
be a morphism in Tc. If q : Coh(T) → Coh(T)/ann(X) is a localisation functor and
q(Ff ) is simple, then there exists some g : C → D in Tc such that q(Ff ) = q(Fg) and
C is indecomposable.
Proof. Suppose A = A′ ⊕ A′′ where A′, A′′ ∈ Tc are nonzero. Since
(A,−) ∼= (A′,−)⊕ (A′′,−),
we have Ff ∼=((A′,−)⊕ (A′′,−)
)/ im(f,−) where we identify im(f,−) with its image
in (A′,−)⊕ (A′′,−). Consider the subfunctors of Ff
(im(f,−)+A)/im(f,−)∼= (A′,−)/im(f,−)∩(A′,−) = H ′
and
(im(f,−)+A)/im(f,−)∼= (A′′,−)/im(f,−)∩(A′′,−) = H ′′.
The sum of these subfunctors is Ff so, since q(Ff ) is simple, the image of at least one
of them under q equals q(Ff ). Hence either q(Ff ) ∼= q(H) or q(Ff ) ∼= q(H ′).
Now, im(f,−) ∩ (A′,−) ⊆ (A′,−) is a finitely generated subfunctor so, by Re-
mark 7.0.1, there exists some g : A′ → B′ in Tc such that im(g,−) ∼= im(f,−)∩(A′,−)
and similarly with A′′ in place of A. As Tc is Krull-Schmidt, the result follows.
7.1. KRULL-GABRIEL ANALYSIS OF COH(K) 149
Proposition 7.1.8. Suppose q0(Ff ) is simple in Coh(K)/ann(X0), then there exists
a 1-simple morphism h such that q0(Ff ) = q0(Fh).
The proof for the finite global dimension case can be found in [14]; our proof applies
to both infinite and finite global dimension.
Proof. If f = gh, then Fh is a factor of Ff . Thus, for any such h, we have that
q0(Fh) ∼= q0(Ff ) if and only if q0(Fh) 6= 0. We have already observed that if h is
a 1-simple morphism, then q0(Fh) 6= 0 so it remains to show that we always have
a factorisation f = gh where h is 1-simple. By Lemma 7.1.7 we may assume that
f : A→⊕n
i=1Bi where A,B1, . . . , Bn are indecomposable objects in Kc.
We observe that the Hom-hammock structure, combined with Proposition 5.3.14,
implies that there is a 1-simple morphism through which f factors, except in the
following cases:
1. A = Xki,j for some 0 ≤ k < r and i ≤ j and Bl = Xk
i,j+t for some t ≥ 0 and
1 ≤ l ≤ n.
2. A = Y ki,j for some 0 ≤ k < r and j ≤ i and Bl = Y k
i+t,j for some t ≥ 0 and
1 ≤ l ≤ n.
3. A = Zki,j for some 0 ≤ k < r and i, j ∈ Z and Bp = Zk
i+t,j, Bq = Zki,j+s for some
t, s ≥ 0 and 1 ≤ p, q ≤ n.
We argue, by contradiction, that none of these cases arise. In each of these cases,
by inspection of the Hom-hammocks, the set of indecomposable compact objects C
for which Ff (C) 6= 0 is finite. By Corollary 7.2.1, the open set (Ff ) contains only
finitely many isolated points of Zg(K). It follows from Lemma 7.0.2, that the Cantor-
Bendixson rank of Zg(K) is defined and so the isolated points are dense (see, for
example, [44, Lem. 5.3.36]). But each isolated point, being of finite endolength, is
closed (see [44, Thm. 5.1.12]) so there are no other points in (Ff ). Since these are the
only points on which Ff is nonzero and since their direct sum is of finite endolength,
it follows that Ff is finite length and q0(Ff ) = 0 which is a contradiction.
Corollary 7.1.9. The simple objects in Coh(K)/ann(X0) are in one-to-one corre-
spondence with the ∼-equivalence classes of 1-simple morphisms.
150 CHAPTER 7. THE ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
Corollary 7.1.10. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra.
1. If gldim Λ = ∞ then the indecomposable, pure-injective complexes of Cantor-
Bendixson rank 1 are exactly the elements of ind(Z).
2. If gldim Λ < ∞ then the indecomposable, pure-injective complexes of Cantor-
Bendixson rank 1 are exactly the elements of ind(X∞ ∪ X−∞ ∪ Y∞ ∪ Y−∞).
Proof. Combine Proposition 7.1.4 with Corollary 7.0.3.
7.1.3 Simple functors in Coh(K)/ann(X1)
We obtain Coh(K)/ann(X1) by localising Coh(K) at the Serre subcategory consisting
of the functors F such that q0(F ) has finite length.
Remark 7.1.11. Since the isolation condition holds and using Proposition 7.1.10, we
may apply a similar argument to the one contained in the proof of Proposition 7.1.8
to obtain that an object q0(F ) in Coh(K)/ann(X0) is finite length if and only if (F )
contains finitely many string complexes of Cantor-Bendixson rank 1.
Proposition 7.1.12. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra of either finite or infinite
global dimension. An object q1(F ) in Coh(K)/ann(X1) is simple if and only if we
have that q1(F ) = q1((Zkj ,−)) for some j, k.
Proof. We give an argument for the case where Λ has infinite global dimension; the
case where Λ has finite global dimension can be found in [14].
Note that, by Remark 7.1.11 and the description of Hom-hammocks in Propo-
sition 5.3.13, the objects q1((Xki,j,−)) = 0 and q1((Zk
j ,−)) 6= 0 for all i, j ∈ Z and
0 ≤ k < r. It follows from this and Lemma 7.1.7 that any simple object will be of
the form q1(Ff ) where f : Zkj → B for some compact object B, j ∈ Z and 0 ≤ k < r.
It remains to show that q1((Zkj ,−)) is simple. Any coherent subobject of q1((Zk
j ,−))
will (by Remark 7.0.1) be the image under q1 of some im(f,−) ⊆ (Zkj ,−) where
f : Zkj →
⊕ni=1Bi with B1, . . . , Bn indecomposable. Note that im(f,−) is the sum of
the im(πif,−) where πi is the projection to Bi. If Bi = Zkt for any 1 ≤ i ≤ n and
t ≥ j, then Remark 7.1.11 and Proposition 5.3.13 gives us that q1(Ff ) = 0 and so
q1((Zkj ,−)) = q1(im(f,−)). So consider the case where Bi ∈ X k+1 for each 1 ≤ i ≤ n.
Then there is an epimorphism (⊕n
i=1Bi,−)→ im(f,−) and so q1(im(f,−)) = 0.
7.2. THE ZIEGLER SPECTRUM 151
This completes the proof of Theorem 7.1.1 since it is clear that everything is finite
length in Coh(K)/ann(X1); that is ann(X2) = Coh(K)2 = Coh(K).
7.2 The Ziegler spectrum
By Corollary 7.0.3, the list of simple functors we have produced at each stage of the
Krull-Gabriel analysis are in bijection with the isolated points at the corresponding
stage of the Cantor-Bendixson analysis. In this section we list the pure-injective com-
plexes of each Cantor-Bendixson rank. We repeat results from the previous sections
for the sake of providing a full list of the points of the Ziegler spectrum.
By Proposition 6.4.2, the infinite string complexes are indecomposable pure-injective
objects in K, that is, they are points of Zg(K). Thus we can determine their Cantor-
Bendixson by matching them to a functor that isolates them. This is not hard to do
given the descriptions of the Hom-hammocks given in Section 5.3 and the resulting
ranks are listed in Sections 7.2.1 to 7.2.3.
The question remains as to whether there are any more indecomposable pure injec-
tive objects in K. The answer is in fact that there are not; this follows from the fact
that every simple object at each stage in the Krull-Gabriel analysis isolates a string
complex and so, again by Corollary 7.0.3, the set of string complexes in K are exactly
the set of indecomposable pure-injective objects in K.
7.2.1 Cantor-Bendixson Rank 0
Proposition 7.2.1. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra
1. If gldim Λ =∞ then ind(X ) is the set of isolated points in Zg(K).
2. If gldim Λ <∞ then ind(X ∪ Y ∪ Z) is the set of isolated points in Zg(K).
Proof. This now follows from Corollary 7.0.3 and the description of Auslander-Reiten
triangles in [13] from which it follows that it is the indecomposable bounded complexes
which begin Auslander-Reiten sequences.
7.2.2 Cantor-Bendixson Rank 1
Proposition 7.2.2. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra.
152 CHAPTER 7. THE ZIEGLER SPECTRUM
1. If gldim Λ = ∞ then the indecomposable, pure-injective complexes of Cantor-
Bendixson rank 1 are exactly the elements of ind(Z).
2. If gldim Λ < ∞ then the indecomposable, pure-injective complexes of Cantor-
Bendixson rank 1 are exactly the elements of ind(X∞ ∪ X−∞ ∪ Y∞ ∪ Y−∞).
Proof. Combine Proposition 7.1.4 with Corollary 7.0.3.
7.2.3 Cantor-Bendixson Rank 2
Proposition 7.2.3. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra of either finite or infinite
global dimension. The set Z∞ is a complete list of all indecomposable, pure-injective
complexes of Cantor-Bendixson rank 2.
Proof. We have already seen that the objects Zk∞ are indecomposable and pure-
injective and it is clear from the Hom-hammocks that the Hom-functors (Zkj ,−) isolate
these points in X2.
7.2.4 Classification of indecomposable pure-injective complexes
Theorem 7.2.4. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra. Then the set of indecompos-
able pure-injective complexes in K(Λ-Proj) is exactly the set of string complexes in
K(Λ-Proj).
Proof. By Proposition 6.4.2, every string complex is indecomposable and pure-injective.
In Sections 7.2.1 to 7.2.3 we have matched every simple object at each stage of the
Krull-Gabriel analysis with a string complex. It follows from Corollary 7.0.3 that we
have a full list of the indecomposable pure-injective complexes.
Chapter 8
Indecomposable objects in the
homotopy category of a
derived-discrete algebra
In this chapter we will use the results of the previous chapter to prove our main result:
that is, every indecomposable complex over a derived-discrete algebra is pure-injective
and therefore is a string complex.
Remark 8.0.5. Although every indecomposable complex over a derived-discrete alge-
bra is pure-injective, there are complexes which are neither pure-injective nor a direct
sum of indecomposable objects, see [11, Thm. 9.3] or [33, Thm. 2.10].
As in the previous section we will let Λ = Λ(r, n,m) be a derived-discrete algebra
and the homotopy category K(Λ-Proj) will be denoted by K.
By the results in Section 6.3, the Ziegler spectrum of K can be seen in two ways:
• The points are indecomposable pure-injective objects of K and the topology is
given by coherent functors F in Coh(K).
• The points are indecomposable injective objects of Abs-Kc (i.e. the functors
(−, N) where N is an indecomposable pure-injective object of K) and the topol-
ogy is given by A in mod-Kc.
The Krull-Gabriel analysis in the last chapter was carried out via iterated local-
isation of Coh(K) ' (mod-Kc)op
with respect to Serre subcategories. As we saw in
153
154 CHAPTER 8. INDECOMPOSABLE OBJECTS IN K(Λ-PROJ)
Section 1.3, there are parallel and compatible localisations of Mod-Kc with respect
to hereditary torsion theories. In order to make use of the torsion theoretic setting,
we will often work in Mod-Kc and then restrict back to Coh(K) ' (mod-Kc)op via
Theorem 1.3.14 and Corollary 6.3.5.
In order to prove that all indecomposable objects in K are pure-injective we will
consider the case where Λ has finite global dimension and the case where Λ has infinite
global dimension separately. Before we consider the separate cases we will prove some
preliminary lemmas. The main idea is that we consider the definable subcategory
generated by an arbitrary indecomposable complex M (see Section 1.2) and show that
if it contains any indecomposable compact object C, then M = C. This reduces the
problem to considering arbitrary indecomposable complex whose support in the Ziegler
spectrum do not contain any compact objects. The terminology used in the following
lemma is that of Section 1.3.5.
Lemma 8.0.6. Let (T ,F) be a finite-type hereditary torsion pair in Mod-Tc and let
q : Mod-Tc → Mod-Tc/T
be the localisation functor with right adjoint given by the canonical embedding functor
i : Mod-Tc/T → Mod-Tc. Suppose G ∈ F and that G is fp-injective. Then G ∼= iq(G).
Proof. Proving the statement amounts to proving that G is injective over all T -dense
embeddings i.e. over embeddings F ′ → F such that F/F ′ ∈ T . Since Mod-Tc is locally
finitely presented, it is enough to check all T -dense embeddings F ′ → F where F is
finitely presented.
So let f : F ′ → F be such an embedding and let g : F ′ → G be an arbitrary
morphism. We must show that there exists some h : F → G such that hf = g. Since
T is a finite-type torsion class, there is a finitely generated T -dense subfunctor F ′′ of
F contained in F ′ (see [44, Prop. 11.1.14]), which must therefore be T -dense in F ′. Let
g′ : F ′′ → G and f ′ : F ′′ → F be the restrictions of g and f to F ′′ respectively. Then
f ′ has a finitely presented cokernel so, since G is fp-injective, there is some h : F → G
such that g′ = hf ′. In other words, g′ − hf ′ = (g − hf)|F ′′ = 0 and so there is an
induced morphism g − hf : F ′/F ′′ → G. Since F ′/F ′′ is torsion and G is torsion-free
we must have g − hf = 0. It therefore follows that g = hf .
155
Lemma 8.0.7. Let M be an object in a compactly generated triangulated category T
and denote the support supp(M) := 〈M〉 ∩ Zg(T) of M by X. Suppose the image of a
functor F in Coh(T)/ann(X) is simple with (F ) ∩X = {C} for some compact object
C. Then C is a direct summand of M .
Proof. Let q : Coh(T)→ Coh(T)/ann(X) and let i : Coh(T)/ann(X)→ Coh(T) be the
canonical embedding (that is, i is right adjoint to q). We will also denote by q and i
the localisation and embedding functors associated to the localisation of Mod-Tc with
respect to the corresponding torsion class T .
Since q(F ) is non-zero in Coh(T)/ann(X), we must have F (M) 6= 0 and also, since
C ∈ (F ) we must have that F (C) 6= 0. Let G be the functor in mod-Tc such that
F = G∨. Since (−)∨ is an equivalence, q(G) must be simple in Mod-Tc/T and, by
definition, 0 6= F (M) = (G, (−,M)) and 0 6= F (C) = (G, (−, C)).
Since the objects (−,M) and (−, C) are torsion-free, we must have that
(q(G), q(−,M)) 6= 0 and (q(G), q(−, C)) 6= 0. Since q(G) is simple, there are em-
beddings
k : q(G)→ q(−,M) and j : q(G)→ q(−, C).
Since C is indecomposable and compact, it is an indecomposable pure-injective object
of T and so q(−, C) is an indecomposable injective object of Mod-Tc/M (see, for
example, [44, Prop. 11.1.31]). It follows that q(−, C) is the injective hull of q(G) and
so j(q(G)) is the simple socle of q(−, C). The morphism j : q(G)→ q(−, C) is between
finitely presented objects so the cokernel is also finitely presented. Since q(−,M) is fp-
injective there is some h : q(−, C)→ q(−,M) such that k = hj. It follows that h must
be a monomorphism because q(G) is the simple essential socle of q(−, C). Moreover,
by Lemma 8.0.6, we have (−, C) ∼= iq(−, C) and (−,M) ∼= iq(−,M). Therefore if we
consider the image of h under i (we shall still denote this by h), we can regard it as a
monomorphism from (−, C) to (−,M). By Yoneda’s lemma (which we may apply as C
is compact) there must be some h′ : C →M and this must be a pure monomorphism.
But C is pure-injective so C must be a direct summand of M .
Corollary 8.0.8. Let M be an indecomposable object in K and suppose there is a
compact object C ∈ X = supp(M). Then C = M .
Proof. First we argue that if C is isolated in X, then C = M . By Corollary 7.0.3,
156 CHAPTER 8. INDECOMPOSABLE OBJECTS IN K(Λ-PROJ)
the isolation condition holds for Zg(K). So there is some F ∈ Coh(K) such that that
{C} = (F )∩X and the image of F in Coh(K)/ann(X) is simple. So by Lemma 8.0.7,
C is a direct summand of M , that is, C = M .
Next we argue that if C ∈ X then C is isolated in X. If C is isolated in Zg(K)
then it is also isolated in X. Otherwise, without loss of generality, supposed X is
contained in the set Zg(K)′ of non-isolated points in Zg(K). In particular, we must
be in the case where Λ has infinite global dimension. By Proposition 7.2.2, the point
C has Cantor-Bendixson rank 1 and so is isolated in Zg(K)′. But then C must also
be isolated in X.
8.1 Indecomposable objects when gldim Λ =∞
We will make use of the notation introduced in Section 5.3.3 for string objects in the
homotopy category of a derived-discrete algebra Λ when gldim Λ =∞.
Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra with gldim Λ =∞. Recall that, for 0 ≤ k < r,
there is a sequence of irreducible morphisms between noncompact, right-infinite string
complexes Xki,∞ (forming the lefthand beams of the ladder type AR components Zk).
· · · // Xki−1,∞
tki−1 // Xki,∞
tki // Xki+1,∞
// · · ·
We define Xk∞ :=
⊕i∈ZX
ki,∞ and write X :=
⊕r−1k=0X
k∞.
The main result of this section will be obtained as a corollary of the fact that
X is Σ-pure-injective. We will consider an arbitrary indecomposable object M in K
and show that the definable subcategory it generates is contained in the definable
subcategory generated by a Σ-pure-injective complex. By Remark 6.4.1, it follows
that M must be Σ-pure-injective. See Section 6.4 for the relevant definitions and
terminology.
Lemma 8.1.1. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra with infinite global dimension. If
C is a string complex determined by a finite homotopy string, then HomK(C,Xk∞)
satisfies the descending chain condition on EndK(Xk∞)-submodules.
Proof. Since C is compact, HomK(C,Xk∞) ∼=
⊕i∈Z HomK(C,Xk
i,∞). The descrip-
tion of the Hom-hammocks given in Proposition 5.3.13 implies that there are only
8.1. INDECOMPOSABLE OBJECTS WHEN gldim Λ =∞ 157
finitely many non-zero direct summands in⊕
i∈Z HomK(C,Xki,∞). Moreover, each
HomK(C,Xki,∞) is a finite-dimensional k-vector space by Proposition 5.3.7. It follows
that HomK(C,Xk∞) satisfies the descending chain condition on EndK(Xk
∞)-submodules.
We now consider the case where C is a right-infinite string complex. That is, C is
compact but is not contained in Kb(Λ-proj) (see Section 5.3.3).
Lemma 8.1.2. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra with infinite global dimension and
suppose C = Z`j for some 0 ≤ ` < r and j ∈ Z. Then HomK(C,Xk
∞) satisfies the
descending chain condition on EndK(Xk∞)-submodules.
Proof. By Proposition 5.3.7, we have dim HomK(C,Xki,∞) ≤ 1. The description of the
Hom-hammocks given in Proposition 5.3.13 gives that there exists an N ∈ Z such
that HomK(C,Xkl,∞) = 0 for all l > N . Also, by Proposition 5.3.7, we have that
dim HomK(C,XkN,∞) = 1 so fix a basis element bN ∈ HomK(C,Xk
N,∞). By Propo-
sition 5.3.14, we can choose a basis element bi ∈ HomK(C,XkN,∞) for each i ≤ N
such that bj = tkj−1 · · · tki bi for all i < j ≤ N . Moreover, since C is compact,
we have HomK(C,Xk∞) ∼=
⊕i∈Z HomK(C,Xk
i,∞) and so {bi | i ≤ N} is a basis for
HomK(C,Xk∞).
Let M be a proper EndK(Xk∞)-submodule of HomK(C,Xk
∞). If bi ∈M for some i,
we must have bi+1 = tki bi ∈M . Since we have assumed that M is a proper submodule,
it follows that {i | bi ∈ M} has a minimal element and therefore M must be finite-
dimensional. It follows that HomK(C,Xk∞) has the descending chain condition on
EndK(Xk∞)-submodules as required.
Proposition 8.1.3. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra with infinite global dimension.
Then the module X is Σ-pure-injective.
Proof. By Lemmas 8.1.1 and 8.1.2 and the fact that HomK(−, Xk∞) commutes with
finite direct sums, we have that HomK(C,Xk∞) satisfies the descending chain condition
for each 0 ≤ k < r and each compact object C. That is, each module Xk∞ for 0 ≤ k < r
is Σ-pure-injective. Then X is Σ-pure-injective by Remark 6.4.1.
Corollary 8.1.4. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra with infinite global dimension.
If an indecomposable object M in K is such that supp(M) contains no compact object,
then M is Σ-pure-injective.
158 CHAPTER 8. INDECOMPOSABLE OBJECTS IN K(Λ-PROJ)
Proof. Recall from the proof of Corollary 6.4.2 that every string complex has finite
endolength and is therefore Σ-pure-injective. Consider Z := X ⊕ (r−1⊕k=0
Zk∞) and note
this is the direct sum of all noncompact indecomposable pure-injective objects in K.
Since it is a finite direct sum of Σ-pure-injective modules it is Σ-pure-injective. Then
〈M〉 ⊆ 〈Z〉 and by Remark 6.4.1, we must have that M is Σ-pure-injective.
Theorem 8.1.5. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra with infinite global dimension.
Then the indecomposable objects of K = K(Λ-Proj) are exactly the (possibly infi-
nite) string complexes StrΛ. In particular, every indecomposable object in K is pure-
injective.
Proof. Let M be an arbitrary indecomposable object in K. Then if supp(M) contains
a compact object, it follows that M is compact. By Proposition 5.3.3, in this case
M is a string complex. If supp(M) does not contain any compact objects then by
Corollary 8.1.4 we have that M is Σ-pure-injective. The classification of the pure-
injective objects in K given in Theorem 7.2.4 gives us that M is an indecomposable
string complex.
8.2 Indecomposable objects when gldim Λ <∞
At the beginning of this chapter we reduced the problem to considering an arbitrary
indecomposable object M in K such that supp(M) does not contain a compact object.
Next we will reduce the problem further so that we need only consider M where
supp(M) contains at least one module of Cantor-Bendixson rank 1 but no compact
objects.
Lemma 8.2.1. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra with finite global dimension and let
M be an indecomposable object in K. If supp(M) contains only points with Cantor-
Bendixson rank 2, then M is Σ-pure-injective.
Proof. Let N be the direct sum of one copy of each object in supp(M). By Corollary
7.2.3, there are only finitely many points with Cantor-Bendixson rank 2. It follows
that N is the direct sum of finitely many Σ-pure-injective complexes and hence is Σ-
pure-injective (by Remark 6.4.1). The definable category 〈N〉 therefore contains only
Σ-pure-injective objects and, in particular, we conclude that M is Σ-pure-injective.
8.2. INDECOMPOSABLE OBJECTS WHEN gldim Λ <∞ 159
Consider the closed set X0 of Zg(K) consisting of all points of Cantor-Bendixson
rank greater than or equal to 1. Then let T0 denote the hereditary torsion class of
finite type in Mod-Kc corresponding to X0. Then let q : Mod-Kc → Mod-Kc/T0 be
the localisation functor with right adjoint i : Mod-Kc/T0 → Mod-Kc given by the
canonical inclusion.
Throughout this section we will consider an arbitrary indecomposable object of K,
which we will denote by M . By Corollary 8.0.8 and Lemma 8.2.1, we may assume that
supp(M) does not contain any compact objects and that there is at least one object
with Cantor-Bendixson rank 1.
Let N be an object of Cantor-Bendixsion rank 1 contained in supp(M). Then,
according to Proposition 7.2.2, we have N is contained in one of the components
X k∞,X k
−∞,Yk∞,Yk−∞ for some 0 ≤ k < r. So, if N lies in X k∞ or Yk∞ for some k, there
is a sequence of indecomposable complexes
N = N1α1−→ N2
α2−→ N3α3−→ N4
α4−→ · · · . (8.1)
and we shall write βn = αn · · ·α2α1 for each n ≥ 1.
If N lies in X k−∞ or Yk−∞ for some k, then there is a sequence of indecomposable
complexes and irreducible morphisms
L1α1−→ L2
α2−→ L3α3−→ L4
α4−→ · · · . (8.2)
in X k∞ or Yk∞ such that there is a non-zero morphism N
γ0−→ L1. We shall write
γn = αn · · ·α1γ0 for each n ≥ 1.
We can embed these sequences in Mod-Kc via the restricted Yoneda embedding to
obtain:
(−, N) = (−, N1)(−,α1)−→ (−, N2)
(−,α2)−→ (−, N3)(−,α3)−→ (−, N4)
(−,α4)−→ · · · .
and
(−, N)(−,γ0)−→ (−, L1)
(−,α1)−→ (−, L2)(−,α2)−→ (−, L3)
(−,α3)−→ · · · .
Lemma 8.2.2. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra with finite global dimension and let
M,N be as above. Then the subfunctors
ker(−, β1)→ ker(−, β2)→ · · · or ker(−, γ0)→ ker(−, γ1)→ · · ·
of (−, N) are such that⋃n≥1 ker(−, βn) = (−, N) or
⋃n≥0 ker(−, γn) = (−, N).
160 CHAPTER 8. INDECOMPOSABLE OBJECTS IN K(Λ-PROJ)
Proof. The functors will be zero on any indecomposable compact object outside of
H−∞(N) and so we only consider these objects (for the notation, see Section 5.3.2,
noting that the backward hom-hammocks are easily deduced from Proposition 5.3.12).
The case where N is contained in X k∞ or Yk∞ for some k and the case where N lies in
X k−∞ or Yk−∞ for some k behave slightly differently. In both cases, the lemma follows
easily from an examination of the Hom-hammocks.
The following diagrams illustrate the calculation required in the case where N is
contained in X k∞ or Yk∞.
N
Nt
Ns
(8.3)
The darkest shaded region shows the objects C such that (C,N) 6= 0 but where
there are non-zero morphisms f : C → N such that f ∈ ker(C, βt+1). The intermediate
shaded region together with the darkest shaded region shows those objects such that
(C,N) 6= 0, and where there are non-zero morphisms f : C → N such that f is in
ker(C, βs+1). The three shaded regions together show objects C such that (C,N) 6= 0.
As we continue to consider the C such that ker(C, βj) 6= 0 for successively larger j,
it is clear that the region covered approaches the region containing all C such that
(C,N) 6= 0.
In exactly the same way, we can consider the case where N is contained in X k−∞ or
Yk−∞. The picture to consider is below.
N
L1
Lt
(8.4)
8.2. INDECOMPOSABLE OBJECTS WHEN gldim Λ <∞ 161
As each (−, Ni) and each (−, Li) is isolated in to closed subset of Zg(Abs-Kc)
corresponding to X0, it follows that each q(−, Ni) and q(−, Li) is the injective hull of
a simple object in Mod-Kc/T0 and, in particular, has a simple socle. We will identify
the functors corresponding to these simple socles and use them to prove the main
result.
Lemma 8.2.3. Let M , N be as above. Then for n ≥ 1 we have
q(ker(−, βn))
q(ker(−, βn−1))∼= q(ker(−, αn)) or
q(ker(−, γn))
q(ker(−, γn−1))∼= q(ker(−, αn))
and q(ker(−, αn)) is a simple functor in Mod-Kc/T0.
Proof. Note that in both cases, there is a morphism
ker(−, βn)
ker(−, βn−1)
ϕ−→ ker(−, αn) orker(−, γn)
ker(−, γn−1)
ϕ−→ ker(−, αn)
and so there are embeddings imϕ→ ker(−, αn).
Comparing the Hom-hammocks, we see that ker(−, αn)/ imϕ is only non-zero on
finitely many indecomposable compact objects (in the first case, they points lying on
the blue dashed coray between the shaded block and the mouth of the component;
and in the second case on the red dotted coray from the red dashed ray to the mouth
of the component). But this implies that ker(−, αn)/ imϕ is a finite length functor
(see Remark 7.1.11) and hence q(ker(−, αn)/ imϕ) = 0 and the first claim follows.
We will now prove the second claim. By Proposition 7.1.9 and Corollary 6.3.5,
we are interested in finding an equivalence class H of 1-simple morphisms such that
for each compact C there exists some h ∈ H such that there exists an embedding
ker(C, αn) → ker(C, h). As the localised functor q(ker(−, αn)) is non-zero, it follows
that q(ker(−, αn)) = q(ker(−, h)) and so q(ker(−, αn)) is simple as claimed. An inspec-
tion of the Hom-hammocks confirms that the following classes fulfil these requirements
(the definitions depend on the notation used in Proposition 5.3.12).
• if N = Xka,∞ take H = {Zk+1
a,j → Zk+1a+1,j ⊕Xk+1
t,a′−1 | j ∈ Z and t ≤ a′ − 1};
• if N = Y k∞,b take H = {Zk+1
i,b → Zk+1i,b+1 ⊕ Y
k+1b′′−1,t | i ∈ Z and t ≥ b′′ − 1};
• if N = Xk−∞,b and L1 = Y k
∞,d take
H = {Zki,d → Zk
i,d+1 ⊕ Y k+1d′′−1,t | i ∈ Z and t ≥ d′′ − 1};
162 CHAPTER 8. INDECOMPOSABLE OBJECTS IN K(Λ-PROJ)
• if N = Y ka,−∞ and L1 = Xk
c,∞ take
H = {Zkc,j → Zk
c+1,j ⊕Xk+1t,c′−1 | i ∈ Z and t ≤ c′ − 1}.
Remark 8.2.4. The proof of the main theorem in this section will require us to
construct a morphism from a infinite string complex to an arbitrary indecomposable
complex. Before we begin this proof we will outline how this construction will work.
Let N be a one-sided infinite string complex. Without loss of generality, suppose that
N comes from a right infinite string (that is, the string (2) in Lemma 5.3.1). Then
there is a ray or coray in the Auslander-Reiten quiver such that, for any subsequence,
C0α0 // C1
α1 // C2α2 // · · ·
of the indecomposable finite string complexes on this ray or coray (where αi is a
composition of irreducible morphisms) we have N = holim−−−→Ci (see [38] for the definition
of homotopy colimit). Moreover, this sequence can be chosen so that
• for each i ≥ 0, the morphism αi is a graph map;
• the left end of each string is fixed and agrees with the left end of the string giving
N ; and
• the number of degrees n in which αni is non-zero strictly increases with i.
Example 8.2.5. This example illustrates what we mean in the above explanation.
Consider the algebra given by the quiver
1c
��−1 a
// 0
b
@@
2d
oo
8.2. INDECOMPOSABLE OBJECTS WHEN gldim Λ <∞ 163
with relations bd = dc = 0. Then we have the following sequence of irreducible maps.
0 d //
1��
2 cba //
1��
−1
1��
2 cb //
1��
0 d //
1��
2
1��
cba // −1
1��
−1 0aoo d //
1��
2 cb //
1��
0 d //
1��
2 cba //
1��
−1
1��
0 d //
1��
2 cb //
1��
0 d //
1��
2 cba //
1��
−1
1��...
......
......
Let M be an arbitrary object in K. If we have a family {hi | hi : Ci →M}i∈N such
that hi+1αi = hi for each i ≥ 0, then clearly we can construct a morphism h : N →M .
That is, for each degree n ∈ Z, let hn = hni for some i ∈ N where αni 6= 0.
Theorem 8.2.6. Let Λ be a derived-discrete algebra with finite global dimension. Then
the indecomposable objects in K = K(Λ-Proj) are exactly the (possibly inifinte) string
complexes StrΛ. In particular, every indecomposable object is pure-injective.
Proof. Suppose for a contradiction, that M is an indecomposable object in K but that
M is not a string complex. Then, by Corollary 8.0.8 and Lemma 8.2.1, we have that
supp(M) does not contain any compact objects and there is at least one object with
Cantor-Bendixson rank 1. As before, let N ∈ supp(M) denote such an object with
Cantor-Bendixson rank 1.
By Lemmas 8.2.2 and 8.2.3, we have q(ker(−, α1)) = q(ker(−, β1)) is the simple
socle of (−, N). Let S denote ker(−, β1). Then S∨ is a coherent functor and S∨(N) 6= 0
and so S∨(M) = (S, (−,M)) 6= 0 since N ∈ 〈M〉. As q(S) is simple, there is an
embedding q(S)→ q(−,M). Moreover, q(−,M) is fp-injective so by Lemma 8.2.3 we
have
q(S) = q(ker(−, β1)) //
��
q(ker(−, β2)) //
∃
uu
q(ker(−, β3)) //
∃
rr
· · · ,
q(−,M).
We can take the direct limit of these embeddings and so there exists an embedding
q(−, N) → q(−,M). Since supp(M) does not contain any isolated points and N has
164 CHAPTER 8. INDECOMPOSABLE OBJECTS IN K(Λ-PROJ)
Cantor-Bendixson rank 1, the functors (−,M) and (−, N) are torsion-free and fp-
injective, so by Lemma 8.0.6, we have iq(−,M) ∼= (−,M) and iq(−, N) ∼= (−, N).
Thus there is an embedding τ : (−, N)→ (−,M).
As N is pure-injective, the functor (−, N) is injective and there must exist some
σ : (−,M) → (−, N) such that στ = 1(−,N). But then, since N is pure-injective,
we have (M,N) ∼= ((−,M), (−, N)), that is, there exists some pure epimorphism
f : M → N such that σ = (−, f). The final step of the proof is to construct some
h : N →M such that fh = 1N since then we may conclude that N ∼= M .
Next we will use the construction in Remark 8.2.4 to produce such an h. Let
C0α0 // C1
α1 // C2α2 // · · ·
be a sequence of compact objects as in Remark 8.2.4. Since the Ci are strictly increas-
ing in length, we must have a morphism ιi : Ci → N for each i ≥ 0 such that each
ιi : Ci → N factors as
Ciαi //
ιi ""
Ci+1.
ιi+1
��N.
. We may then apply the functors τ and σ to this sequence to obtain the following
commutative diagram where τi := τ(Ci) for each i ≥ 0.
(C0,M)(C0,f)
11 (C0, N)τ0qq
(C1,M)(C1,f)
11
(α0,M)
OO
(C1, N)τ1qq
(α0,N)
OO
(C2,M)(C2,f)
11
(α1,M)
OO
(C2, N)τ2qq
(α1,N)
OO
From the commutativity of the squares in the tower above, we get
Ciαi //
τi(ιi) ""
Ci+1
τi(ιi+1)��M
and thus we have a family of morphisms {τi(ιi) | τi(ιi) : Ci →M}i∈N with the proper-
ties described in Remark 8.2.4. Let h : N →M be the morphism constructed from this
8.2. INDECOMPOSABLE OBJECTS WHEN gldim Λ <∞ 165
family. Since the ιi are graph maps and στ = 1(−,N), it follows that for each degree
n ∈ Z such that Nn 6= 0, we have (fh)n = 1Nn and hence fh = 1N as desired.
Bibliography
[1] K. K. Arnesen, R. Laking, and D. Pauksztello. Morphisms between inde-
composable complexes in the bounded derived category of a gentle algebra.
arXiv:1411.7644, 2015.
[2] K. K. Arnesen, R. Laking, D. Pauksztello, and M. Prest. The ziegler spectrum of
a derived-discrete algebra. arXiv:1603.00775, 2016.
[3] Ibrahim Assem and Dieter Happel. Generalized tilted algebras of type An. Comm.
Algebra, 9(20):2101–2125, 1981.
[4] Ibrahim Assem and Andrzej Skowronski. Iterated tilted algebras of type An.
Math. Z., 195(2):269–290, 1987.
[5] M. Auslander. Representation theory of Artin algebras. II. Comm. Algebra,
1:269–310, 1974.
[6] Maurice Auslander. Representation theory of Artin algebras. I, II. Comm. Alge-
bra, 1:177–268; ibid. 1 (1974), 269–310, 1974.
[7] Maurice Auslander. A functorial approach to representation theory. In Represen-
tations of algebras (Puebla, 1980), volume 944 of Lecture Notes in Math., pages
105–179. Springer, Berlin-New York, 1982.
[8] Maurice Auslander. Isolated singularities and existence of almost split sequences.
In Representation theory, II (Ottawa, Ont., 1984), volume 1178 of Lecture Notes
in Math., pages 194–242. Springer, Berlin, 1986.
[9] Walter Baur. Elimination of quantifiers for modules. Israel J. Math., 25(1-2):64–
70, 1976.
166
BIBLIOGRAPHY 167
[10] V. Bekkert and H. A. Merklen. Indecomposables in derived categories of gentle
algebras. Algebr. Represent. Theory, 6(3):285–302, 2003.
[11] A. Beligiannis. Relative homological algebra and purity in triangulated categories.
J. Algebra, 227(1):268–361, 2000.
[12] G. Bobinski. The almost split triangles for perfect complexes over gentle algebras.
J. Pure Appl. Algebra, 215(4):642–654, 2011.
[13] G. Bobinski, C. Geiß, and A. Skowronski. Classification of discrete derived cate-
gories. Cent. Eur. J. Math., 2(1):19–49 (electronic), 2004.
[14] G. Bobinski and H. Krause. The Krull-Gabriel dimension of discrete derived
categories. arXiv:1402.1596, 2014.
[15] N. Broomhead, D. Pauksztello, and D. Ploog. Discrete derived categories I: Ho-
momorphisms, autoequivalences and t-structures. arXiv:1312.5203, 2013.
[16] M. C. R. Butler and C. M. Ringel. Auslander-Reiten sequences with few middle
terms and applications to string algebras. Comm. Algebra, 15(1-2):145–179, 1987.
[17] W. W. Crawley-Boevey. On tame algebras and bocses. Proc. London Math. Soc.
(3), 56(3):451–483, 1988.
[18] W. W. Crawley-Boevey. Maps between representations of zero-relation algebras.
J. Algebra, 126(2):259–263, 1989.
[19] W. W. Crawley-Boevey. Infinite-dimensional modules in the representation theory
of finite-dimensional algebras. In Algebras and modules, I (Trondheim, 1996),
volume 23 of CMS Conf. Proc., pages 29–54. Amer. Math. Soc., Providence, RI,
1998.
[20] P. W. Donovan and M.-R. Freislich. The indecomposable modular representations
of certain groups with dihedral Sylow subgroup. Math. Ann., 238(3):207–216,
1978.
[21] Ju. A. Drozd. Tame and wild matrix problems. In Representation theory, II
(Proc. Second Internat. Conf., Carleton Univ., Ottawa, Ont., 1979), volume 832
of Lecture Notes in Math., pages 242–258. Springer, Berlin-New York, 1980.
168 BIBLIOGRAPHY
[22] Paul C. Eklof and Edward R. Fischer. The elementary theory of abelian groups.
Ann. Math. Logic, 4:115–171, 1972.
[23] I. M. Gel’fand and V. A. Ponomarev. Indecomposable representations of the
Lorentz group. Uspehi Mat. Nauk, 23(2 (140)):3–60, 1968.
[24] L. Gruson and C. U. Jensen. Dimensions cohomologiques reliees aux foncteurs
lim←−(i). In Paul Dubreil and Marie-Paule Malliavin Algebra Seminar, 33rd Year
(Paris, 1980), volume 867, pages 234–294. Springer, Berlin-New York, 1981.
[25] Ivo Herzog. Elementary duality of modules. Trans. Amer. Math. Soc., 340(1):37–
69, 1993.
[26] Ivo Herzog. The Ziegler spectrum of a locally coherent Grothendieck category.
Proc. London Math. Soc. (3), 74(3):503–558, 1997.
[27] Peter Jørgensen. The homotopy category of complexes of projective modules.
Adv. Math., 193(1):223–232, 2005.
[28] Steffen Konig and Alexander Zimmermann. Derived equivalences for group rings,
volume 1685. Springer-Verlag, Berlin, 1998.
[29] H. Krause. Maps between tree and band modules. J. Algebra, 137(1):186–194,
1991.
[30] Henning Krause. The spectrum of a locally coherent category. J. Pure Appl.
Algebra, 114(3):259–271, 1997.
[31] Henning Krause. Exactly definable categories. J. Algebra, 201(2):456–492, 1998.
[32] Henning Krause. Generic modules over Artin algebras. Proc. London Math. Soc.
(3), 76(2):276–306, 1998.
[33] Henning Krause. Smashing subcategories and the telescope conjecture—an alge-
braic approach. Invent. Math., 139(1):99–133, 2000.
[34] Henning Krause. The spectrum of a module category. Mem. Amer. Math. Soc.,
149(707):x+125, 2001.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 169
[35] Henning Krause. Coherent functors in stable homotopy theory. Fund. Math.,
173(1):33–56, 2002.
[36] R. Laking, M. Prest, and G. Puninski. Krull-gabriel dimension of domestic string
algebras. arXiv:1506.07703, 2015.
[37] Leonard Gaines Monk. Elementary-recursive decision procedures. ProQuest LLC,
Ann Arbor, MI, 1975.
[38] Amnon Neeman. Triangulated categories, volume 148 of Annals of Mathematics
Studies. Princeton University Press, Princeton, NJ, 2001.
[39] Amnon Neeman. The homotopy category of flat modules, and Grothendieck
duality. Invent. Math., 174(2):255–308, 2008.
[40] N. Popescu. Abelian categories with applications to rings and modules. Academic
Press, London-New York, 1973.
[41] Mike Prest. Model theory and modules, volume 130 of London Mathematical
Society Lecture Note Series. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, 1988.
[42] Mike Prest. Representation embeddings and the Ziegler spectrum. J. Pure Appl.
Algebra, 113(3):315–323, 1996.
[43] Mike Prest. Ideals in mod-R and the ω-radical. J. London Math. Soc. (2),
71(2):321–334, 2005.
[44] Mike Prest. Purity, spectra and localisation, volume 121 of Encyclopedia of Math-
ematics and its Applications. Cambridge University Press, Cambridge, 2009.
[45] Mike Prest. Categories of imaginaries for definable additive categories. arXiv,
1202:0427, 2012.
[46] Mike Prest and Gena Puninski. One-directed indecomposable pure injective mod-
ules over string algebras. Colloq. Math., 101(1):89–112, 2004.
[47] Mike Prest and Jan Schroer. Serial functors, Jacobson radical and representation
type. J. Pure Appl. Algebra, 170(2-3):295–307, 2002.
170 BIBLIOGRAPHY
[48] Gena Puninski and Mike Prest. Ringel’s conjecture for domestic string algebras.
Math. Z., 282(1-2):61–77, 2016.
[49] Claus Michael Ringel. The indecomposable representations of the dihedral 2-
groups. Math. Ann., 214:19–34, 1975.
[50] Claus Michael Ringel. Some algebraically compact modules. I. In Abelian groups
and modules (Padova, 1994), volume 343 of Math. Appl., pages 419–439. Kluwer
Acad. Publ., Dordrecht, 1995.
[51] J. E. Roos. Locally Noetherian categories and generalized strictly linearly compact
rings. Applications. In Category Theory, Homology Theory and their Applications,
II, volume 2, pages 197–277. Springer, Berlin, 1969.
[52] J. Schroer. Hammocks for string algebras. PhD thesis, Universitat Bielefeld,
Sonderforschungsbereich 343, Erganzungreihe 97–010, 1997.
[53] Jan Schroer. The Krull-Gabriel dimension of an algebra—open problems and con-
jectures. In Infinite length modules (Bielefeld, 1998), Trends Math. Birkhauser,
Basel, 2000.
[54] Jan Schroer. On the infinite radical of a module category. Proc. London Math.
Soc. (3), 81(3):651–674, 2000.
[55] Jan Schroer. On the Krull-Gabriel dimension of an algebra. Math. Z., 233(2):287–
303, 2000.
[56] Andrzej Skowronski. The Krull-Gabriel Dimension of Cycle-Finite Artin Algebras.
Algebr. Represent. Theory, 19(1):215–233, 2016.
[57] D. Vossieck. The algebras with discrete derived category. J. Algebra, 243(1):168–
176, 2001.
[58] B. Wald and J. Waschbusch. Tame biserial algebras. J. Algebra, 95(2):480–500,
1985.
[59] Han Zhe. The homotopy categories of injective modules of derived discrete alge-
bras. PhD thesis, Bielefeld University, 2013.
BIBLIOGRAPHY 171
[60] Martin Ziegler. Model theory of modules. Ann. Pure Appl. Logic, 26(2):149–213,
1984.
[61] Birge Zimmermann-Huisgen and Wolfgang Zimmermann. On the sparsity of rep-
resentations of rings of pure global dimension zero. Trans. Amer. Math. Soc.,
320(2):695–711, 1990.